Home | History | Annotate | Line # | Download | only in CodeGen
      1 //===- CodeGenPrepare.cpp - Prepare a function for code generation --------===//
      2 //
      3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
      4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
      5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
      6 //
      7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
      8 //
      9 // This pass munges the code in the input function to better prepare it for
     10 // SelectionDAG-based code generation. This works around limitations in it's
     11 // basic-block-at-a-time approach. It should eventually be removed.
     12 //
     13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
     14 
     15 #include "llvm/ADT/APInt.h"
     16 #include "llvm/ADT/ArrayRef.h"
     17 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
     18 #include "llvm/ADT/MapVector.h"
     19 #include "llvm/ADT/PointerIntPair.h"
     20 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
     21 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
     22 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
     23 #include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
     24 #include "llvm/Analysis/BlockFrequencyInfo.h"
     25 #include "llvm/Analysis/BranchProbabilityInfo.h"
     26 #include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
     27 #include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
     28 #include "llvm/Analysis/LoopInfo.h"
     29 #include "llvm/Analysis/MemoryBuiltins.h"
     30 #include "llvm/Analysis/ProfileSummaryInfo.h"
     31 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetLibraryInfo.h"
     32 #include "llvm/Analysis/TargetTransformInfo.h"
     33 #include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
     34 #include "llvm/Analysis/VectorUtils.h"
     35 #include "llvm/CodeGen/Analysis.h"
     36 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ISDOpcodes.h"
     37 #include "llvm/CodeGen/SelectionDAGNodes.h"
     38 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetLowering.h"
     39 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetPassConfig.h"
     40 #include "llvm/CodeGen/TargetSubtargetInfo.h"
     41 #include "llvm/CodeGen/ValueTypes.h"
     42 #include "llvm/Config/llvm-config.h"
     43 #include "llvm/IR/Argument.h"
     44 #include "llvm/IR/Attributes.h"
     45 #include "llvm/IR/BasicBlock.h"
     46 #include "llvm/IR/Constant.h"
     47 #include "llvm/IR/Constants.h"
     48 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
     49 #include "llvm/IR/DebugInfo.h"
     50 #include "llvm/IR/DerivedTypes.h"
     51 #include "llvm/IR/Dominators.h"
     52 #include "llvm/IR/Function.h"
     53 #include "llvm/IR/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
     54 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalValue.h"
     55 #include "llvm/IR/GlobalVariable.h"
     56 #include "llvm/IR/IRBuilder.h"
     57 #include "llvm/IR/InlineAsm.h"
     58 #include "llvm/IR/InstrTypes.h"
     59 #include "llvm/IR/Instruction.h"
     60 #include "llvm/IR/Instructions.h"
     61 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicInst.h"
     62 #include "llvm/IR/Intrinsics.h"
     63 #include "llvm/IR/IntrinsicsAArch64.h"
     64 #include "llvm/IR/LLVMContext.h"
     65 #include "llvm/IR/MDBuilder.h"
     66 #include "llvm/IR/Module.h"
     67 #include "llvm/IR/Operator.h"
     68 #include "llvm/IR/PatternMatch.h"
     69 #include "llvm/IR/Statepoint.h"
     70 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
     71 #include "llvm/IR/Use.h"
     72 #include "llvm/IR/User.h"
     73 #include "llvm/IR/Value.h"
     74 #include "llvm/IR/ValueHandle.h"
     75 #include "llvm/IR/ValueMap.h"
     76 #include "llvm/InitializePasses.h"
     77 #include "llvm/Pass.h"
     78 #include "llvm/Support/BlockFrequency.h"
     79 #include "llvm/Support/BranchProbability.h"
     80 #include "llvm/Support/Casting.h"
     81 #include "llvm/Support/CommandLine.h"
     82 #include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
     83 #include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
     84 #include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
     85 #include "llvm/Support/MachineValueType.h"
     86 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
     87 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
     88 #include "llvm/Target/TargetMachine.h"
     89 #include "llvm/Target/TargetOptions.h"
     90 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
     91 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BypassSlowDivision.h"
     92 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
     93 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SimplifyLibCalls.h"
     94 #include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/SizeOpts.h"
     95 #include <algorithm>
     96 #include <cassert>
     97 #include <cstdint>
     98 #include <iterator>
     99 #include <limits>
    100 #include <memory>
    101 #include <utility>
    102 #include <vector>
    103 
    104 using namespace llvm;
    105 using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
    106 
    107 #define DEBUG_TYPE "codegenprepare"
    108 
    109 STATISTIC(NumBlocksElim, "Number of blocks eliminated");
    110 STATISTIC(NumPHIsElim,   "Number of trivial PHIs eliminated");
    111 STATISTIC(NumGEPsElim,   "Number of GEPs converted to casts");
    112 STATISTIC(NumCmpUses, "Number of uses of Cmp expressions replaced with uses of "
    113                       "sunken Cmps");
    114 STATISTIC(NumCastUses, "Number of uses of Cast expressions replaced with uses "
    115                        "of sunken Casts");
    116 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInsts, "Number of memory instructions whose address "
    117                           "computations were sunk");
    118 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated,
    119           "Number of phis created when address "
    120           "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
    121 STATISTIC(NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated,
    122           "Number of select created when address "
    123           "computations were sunk to memory instructions");
    124 STATISTIC(NumExtsMoved,  "Number of [s|z]ext instructions combined with loads");
    125 STATISTIC(NumExtUses,    "Number of uses of [s|z]ext instructions optimized");
    126 STATISTIC(NumAndsAdded,
    127           "Number of and mask instructions added to form ext loads");
    128 STATISTIC(NumAndUses, "Number of uses of and mask instructions optimized");
    129 STATISTIC(NumRetsDup,    "Number of return instructions duplicated");
    130 STATISTIC(NumDbgValueMoved, "Number of debug value instructions moved");
    131 STATISTIC(NumSelectsExpanded, "Number of selects turned into branches");
    132 STATISTIC(NumStoreExtractExposed, "Number of store(extractelement) exposed");
    133 
    134 static cl::opt<bool> DisableBranchOpts(
    135   "disable-cgp-branch-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    136   cl::desc("Disable branch optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
    137 
    138 static cl::opt<bool>
    139     DisableGCOpts("disable-cgp-gc-opts", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    140                   cl::desc("Disable GC optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
    141 
    142 static cl::opt<bool> DisableSelectToBranch(
    143   "disable-cgp-select2branch", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    144   cl::desc("Disable select to branch conversion."));
    145 
    146 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkUsingGEPs(
    147   "addr-sink-using-gep", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    148   cl::desc("Address sinking in CGP using GEPs."));
    149 
    150 static cl::opt<bool> EnableAndCmpSinking(
    151    "enable-andcmp-sinking", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    152    cl::desc("Enable sinkinig and/cmp into branches."));
    153 
    154 static cl::opt<bool> DisableStoreExtract(
    155     "disable-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    156     cl::desc("Disable store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
    157 
    158 static cl::opt<bool> StressStoreExtract(
    159     "stress-cgp-store-extract", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    160     cl::desc("Stress test store(extract) optimizations in CodeGenPrepare"));
    161 
    162 static cl::opt<bool> DisableExtLdPromotion(
    163     "disable-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    164     cl::desc("Disable ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) optimization in "
    165              "CodeGenPrepare"));
    166 
    167 static cl::opt<bool> StressExtLdPromotion(
    168     "stress-cgp-ext-ld-promotion", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    169     cl::desc("Stress test ext(promotable(ld)) -> promoted(ext(ld)) "
    170              "optimization in CodeGenPrepare"));
    171 
    172 static cl::opt<bool> DisablePreheaderProtect(
    173     "disable-preheader-prot", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    174     cl::desc("Disable protection against removing loop preheaders"));
    175 
    176 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix(
    177     "profile-guided-section-prefix", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true), cl::ZeroOrMore,
    178     cl::desc("Use profile info to add section prefix for hot/cold functions"));
    179 
    180 static cl::opt<bool> ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection(
    181     "profile-unknown-in-special-section", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    182     cl::ZeroOrMore,
    183     cl::desc("In profiling mode like sampleFDO, if a function doesn't have "
    184              "profile, we cannot tell the function is cold for sure because "
    185              "it may be a function newly added without ever being sampled. "
    186              "With the flag enabled, compiler can put such profile unknown "
    187              "functions into a special section, so runtime system can choose "
    188              "to handle it in a different way than .text section, to save "
    189              "RAM for example. "));
    190 
    191 static cl::opt<unsigned> FreqRatioToSkipMerge(
    192     "cgp-freq-ratio-to-skip-merge", cl::Hidden, cl::init(2),
    193     cl::desc("Skip merging empty blocks if (frequency of empty block) / "
    194              "(frequency of destination block) is greater than this ratio"));
    195 
    196 static cl::opt<bool> ForceSplitStore(
    197     "force-split-store", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    198     cl::desc("Force store splitting no matter what the target query says."));
    199 
    200 static cl::opt<bool>
    201 EnableTypePromotionMerge("cgp-type-promotion-merge", cl::Hidden,
    202     cl::desc("Enable merging of redundant sexts when one is dominating"
    203     " the other."), cl::init(true));
    204 
    205 static cl::opt<bool> DisableComplexAddrModes(
    206     "disable-complex-addr-modes", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    207     cl::desc("Disables combining addressing modes with different parts "
    208              "in optimizeMemoryInst."));
    209 
    210 static cl::opt<bool>
    211 AddrSinkNewPhis("addr-sink-new-phis", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    212                 cl::desc("Allow creation of Phis in Address sinking."));
    213 
    214 static cl::opt<bool>
    215 AddrSinkNewSelects("addr-sink-new-select", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    216                    cl::desc("Allow creation of selects in Address sinking."));
    217 
    218 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseReg(
    219     "addr-sink-combine-base-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    220     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseReg field in Address sinking."));
    221 
    222 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseGV(
    223     "addr-sink-combine-base-gv", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    224     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseGV field in Address sinking."));
    225 
    226 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs(
    227     "addr-sink-combine-base-offs", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    228     cl::desc("Allow combining of BaseOffs field in Address sinking."));
    229 
    230 static cl::opt<bool> AddrSinkCombineScaledReg(
    231     "addr-sink-combine-scaled-reg", cl::Hidden, cl::init(true),
    232     cl::desc("Allow combining of ScaledReg field in Address sinking."));
    233 
    234 static cl::opt<bool>
    235     EnableGEPOffsetSplit("cgp-split-large-offset-gep", cl::Hidden,
    236                          cl::init(true),
    237                          cl::desc("Enable splitting large offset of GEP."));
    238 
    239 static cl::opt<bool> EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST(
    240     "cgp-icmp-eq2icmp-st", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    241     cl::desc("Enable ICMP_EQ to ICMP_S(L|G)T conversion."));
    242 
    243 static cl::opt<bool>
    244     VerifyBFIUpdates("cgp-verify-bfi-updates", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    245                      cl::desc("Enable BFI update verification for "
    246                               "CodeGenPrepare."));
    247 
    248 static cl::opt<bool> OptimizePhiTypes(
    249     "cgp-optimize-phi-types", cl::Hidden, cl::init(false),
    250     cl::desc("Enable converting phi types in CodeGenPrepare"));
    251 
    252 namespace {
    253 
    254 enum ExtType {
    255   ZeroExtension,   // Zero extension has been seen.
    256   SignExtension,   // Sign extension has been seen.
    257   BothExtension    // This extension type is used if we saw sext after
    258                    // ZeroExtension had been set, or if we saw zext after
    259                    // SignExtension had been set. It makes the type
    260                    // information of a promoted instruction invalid.
    261 };
    262 
    263 using SetOfInstrs = SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16>;
    264 using TypeIsSExt = PointerIntPair<Type *, 2, ExtType>;
    265 using InstrToOrigTy = DenseMap<Instruction *, TypeIsSExt>;
    266 using SExts = SmallVector<Instruction *, 16>;
    267 using ValueToSExts = DenseMap<Value *, SExts>;
    268 
    269 class TypePromotionTransaction;
    270 
    271   class CodeGenPrepare : public FunctionPass {
    272     const TargetMachine *TM = nullptr;
    273     const TargetSubtargetInfo *SubtargetInfo;
    274     const TargetLowering *TLI = nullptr;
    275     const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI;
    276     const TargetTransformInfo *TTI = nullptr;
    277     const TargetLibraryInfo *TLInfo;
    278     const LoopInfo *LI;
    279     std::unique_ptr<BlockFrequencyInfo> BFI;
    280     std::unique_ptr<BranchProbabilityInfo> BPI;
    281     ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI;
    282 
    283     /// As we scan instructions optimizing them, this is the next instruction
    284     /// to optimize. Transforms that can invalidate this should update it.
    285     BasicBlock::iterator CurInstIterator;
    286 
    287     /// Keeps track of non-local addresses that have been sunk into a block.
    288     /// This allows us to avoid inserting duplicate code for blocks with
    289     /// multiple load/stores of the same address. The usage of WeakTrackingVH
    290     /// enables SunkAddrs to be treated as a cache whose entries can be
    291     /// invalidated if a sunken address computation has been erased.
    292     ValueMap<Value*, WeakTrackingVH> SunkAddrs;
    293 
    294     /// Keeps track of all instructions inserted for the current function.
    295     SetOfInstrs InsertedInsts;
    296 
    297     /// Keeps track of the type of the related instruction before their
    298     /// promotion for the current function.
    299     InstrToOrigTy PromotedInsts;
    300 
    301     /// Keep track of instructions removed during promotion.
    302     SetOfInstrs RemovedInsts;
    303 
    304     /// Keep track of sext chains based on their initial value.
    305     DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *> SeenChainsForSExt;
    306 
    307     /// Keep track of GEPs accessing the same data structures such as structs or
    308     /// arrays that are candidates to be split later because of their large
    309     /// size.
    310     MapVector<
    311         AssertingVH<Value>,
    312         SmallVector<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>, 32>>
    313         LargeOffsetGEPMap;
    314 
    315     /// Keep track of new GEP base after splitting the GEPs having large offset.
    316     SmallSet<AssertingVH<Value>, 2> NewGEPBases;
    317 
    318     /// Map serial numbers to Large offset GEPs.
    319     DenseMap<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int> LargeOffsetGEPID;
    320 
    321     /// Keep track of SExt promoted.
    322     ValueToSExts ValToSExtendedUses;
    323 
    324     /// True if the function has the OptSize attribute.
    325     bool OptSize;
    326 
    327     /// DataLayout for the Function being processed.
    328     const DataLayout *DL = nullptr;
    329 
    330     /// Building the dominator tree can be expensive, so we only build it
    331     /// lazily and update it when required.
    332     std::unique_ptr<DominatorTree> DT;
    333 
    334   public:
    335     static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
    336 
    337     CodeGenPrepare() : FunctionPass(ID) {
    338       initializeCodeGenPreparePass(*PassRegistry::getPassRegistry());
    339     }
    340 
    341     bool runOnFunction(Function &F) override;
    342 
    343     StringRef getPassName() const override { return "CodeGen Prepare"; }
    344 
    345     void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const override {
    346       // FIXME: When we can selectively preserve passes, preserve the domtree.
    347       AU.addRequired<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>();
    348       AU.addRequired<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>();
    349       AU.addRequired<TargetPassConfig>();
    350       AU.addRequired<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>();
    351       AU.addRequired<LoopInfoWrapperPass>();
    352     }
    353 
    354   private:
    355     template <typename F>
    356     void resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BasicBlock *BB, F f) {
    357       // Substituting can cause recursive simplifications, which can invalidate
    358       // our iterator.  Use a WeakTrackingVH to hold onto it in case this
    359       // happens.
    360       Value *CurValue = &*CurInstIterator;
    361       WeakTrackingVH IterHandle(CurValue);
    362 
    363       f();
    364 
    365       // If the iterator instruction was recursively deleted, start over at the
    366       // start of the block.
    367       if (IterHandle != CurValue) {
    368         CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
    369         SunkAddrs.clear();
    370       }
    371     }
    372 
    373     // Get the DominatorTree, building if necessary.
    374     DominatorTree &getDT(Function &F) {
    375       if (!DT)
    376         DT = std::make_unique<DominatorTree>(F);
    377       return *DT;
    378     }
    379 
    380     void removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V);
    381     bool eliminateAssumptions(Function &F);
    382     bool eliminateFallThrough(Function &F);
    383     bool eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F);
    384     BasicBlock *findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
    385     bool canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB, const BasicBlock *DestBB) const;
    386     void eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB);
    387     bool isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB, BasicBlock *DestBB,
    388                                        bool isPreheader);
    389     bool makeBitReverse(Instruction &I);
    390     bool optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, bool &ModifiedDT);
    391     bool optimizeInst(Instruction *I, bool &ModifiedDT);
    392     bool optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr,
    393                             Type *AccessTy, unsigned AddrSpace);
    394     bool optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Ptr);
    395     bool optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS);
    396     bool optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, bool &ModifiedDT);
    397     bool optimizeExt(Instruction *&I);
    398     bool optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I);
    399     bool optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load);
    400     bool optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *BO);
    401     bool optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh);
    402     bool optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI);
    403     bool optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI);
    404     bool optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI);
    405     bool optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst);
    406     bool dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB, bool &ModifiedDT);
    407     bool fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I);
    408     bool placeDbgValues(Function &F);
    409     bool placePseudoProbes(Function &F);
    410     bool canFormExtLd(const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts,
    411                       LoadInst *&LI, Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted);
    412     bool tryToPromoteExts(TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
    413                           const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
    414                           SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
    415                           unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0);
    416     bool mergeSExts(Function &F);
    417     bool splitLargeGEPOffsets();
    418     bool optimizePhiType(PHINode *Inst, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
    419                          SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs);
    420     bool optimizePhiTypes(Function &F);
    421     bool performAddressTypePromotion(
    422         Instruction *&Inst,
    423         bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
    424         bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
    425         SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts);
    426     bool splitBranchCondition(Function &F, bool &ModifiedDT);
    427     bool simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I);
    428 
    429     bool tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I);
    430     bool replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO, Value *Arg0,
    431                                      Value *Arg1, CmpInst *Cmp,
    432                                      Intrinsic::ID IID);
    433     bool optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, bool &ModifiedDT);
    434     bool combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, bool &ModifiedDT);
    435     bool combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp, bool &ModifiedDT);
    436     void verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F);
    437   };
    438 
    439 } // end anonymous namespace
    440 
    441 char CodeGenPrepare::ID = 0;
    442 
    443 INITIALIZE_PASS_BEGIN(CodeGenPrepare, DEBUG_TYPE,
    444                       "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
    445 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(LoopInfoWrapperPass)
    446 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass)
    447 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass)
    448 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetPassConfig)
    449 INITIALIZE_PASS_DEPENDENCY(TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass)
    450 INITIALIZE_PASS_END(CodeGenPrepare, DEBUG_TYPE,
    451                     "Optimize for code generation", false, false)
    452 
    453 FunctionPass *llvm::createCodeGenPreparePass() { return new CodeGenPrepare(); }
    454 
    455 bool CodeGenPrepare::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
    456   if (skipFunction(F))
    457     return false;
    458 
    459   DL = &F.getParent()->getDataLayout();
    460 
    461   bool EverMadeChange = false;
    462   // Clear per function information.
    463   InsertedInsts.clear();
    464   PromotedInsts.clear();
    465 
    466   TM = &getAnalysis<TargetPassConfig>().getTM<TargetMachine>();
    467   SubtargetInfo = TM->getSubtargetImpl(F);
    468   TLI = SubtargetInfo->getTargetLowering();
    469   TRI = SubtargetInfo->getRegisterInfo();
    470   TLInfo = &getAnalysis<TargetLibraryInfoWrapperPass>().getTLI(F);
    471   TTI = &getAnalysis<TargetTransformInfoWrapperPass>().getTTI(F);
    472   LI = &getAnalysis<LoopInfoWrapperPass>().getLoopInfo();
    473   BPI.reset(new BranchProbabilityInfo(F, *LI));
    474   BFI.reset(new BlockFrequencyInfo(F, *BPI, *LI));
    475   PSI = &getAnalysis<ProfileSummaryInfoWrapperPass>().getPSI();
    476   OptSize = F.hasOptSize();
    477   if (ProfileGuidedSectionPrefix) {
    478     // The hot attribute overwrites profile count based hotness while profile
    479     // counts based hotness overwrite the cold attribute.
    480     // This is a conservative behabvior.
    481     if (F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Hot) ||
    482         PSI->isFunctionHotInCallGraph(&F, *BFI))
    483       F.setSectionPrefix("hot");
    484     // If PSI shows this function is not hot, we will placed the function
    485     // into unlikely section if (1) PSI shows this is a cold function, or
    486     // (2) the function has a attribute of cold.
    487     else if (PSI->isFunctionColdInCallGraph(&F, *BFI) ||
    488              F.hasFnAttribute(Attribute::Cold))
    489       F.setSectionPrefix("unlikely");
    490     else if (ProfileUnknownInSpecialSection && PSI->hasPartialSampleProfile() &&
    491              PSI->isFunctionHotnessUnknown(F))
    492       F.setSectionPrefix("unknown");
    493   }
    494 
    495   /// This optimization identifies DIV instructions that can be
    496   /// profitably bypassed and carried out with a shorter, faster divide.
    497   if (!OptSize && !PSI->hasHugeWorkingSetSize() && TLI->isSlowDivBypassed()) {
    498     const DenseMap<unsigned int, unsigned int> &BypassWidths =
    499         TLI->getBypassSlowDivWidths();
    500     BasicBlock* BB = &*F.begin();
    501     while (BB != nullptr) {
    502       // bypassSlowDivision may create new BBs, but we don't want to reapply the
    503       // optimization to those blocks.
    504       BasicBlock* Next = BB->getNextNode();
    505       // F.hasOptSize is already checked in the outer if statement.
    506       if (!llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
    507         EverMadeChange |= bypassSlowDivision(BB, BypassWidths);
    508       BB = Next;
    509     }
    510   }
    511 
    512   // Get rid of @llvm.assume builtins before attempting to eliminate empty
    513   // blocks, since there might be blocks that only contain @llvm.assume calls
    514   // (plus arguments that we can get rid of).
    515   EverMadeChange |= eliminateAssumptions(F);
    516 
    517   // Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes and an
    518   // unconditional branch.
    519   EverMadeChange |= eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(F);
    520 
    521   bool ModifiedDT = false;
    522   if (!DisableBranchOpts)
    523     EverMadeChange |= splitBranchCondition(F, ModifiedDT);
    524 
    525   // Split some critical edges where one of the sources is an indirect branch,
    526   // to help generate sane code for PHIs involving such edges.
    527   EverMadeChange |= SplitIndirectBrCriticalEdges(F);
    528 
    529   bool MadeChange = true;
    530   while (MadeChange) {
    531     MadeChange = false;
    532     DT.reset();
    533     for (Function::iterator I = F.begin(); I != F.end(); ) {
    534       BasicBlock *BB = &*I++;
    535       bool ModifiedDTOnIteration = false;
    536       MadeChange |= optimizeBlock(*BB, ModifiedDTOnIteration);
    537 
    538       // Restart BB iteration if the dominator tree of the Function was changed
    539       if (ModifiedDTOnIteration)
    540         break;
    541     }
    542     if (EnableTypePromotionMerge && !ValToSExtendedUses.empty())
    543       MadeChange |= mergeSExts(F);
    544     if (!LargeOffsetGEPMap.empty())
    545       MadeChange |= splitLargeGEPOffsets();
    546     MadeChange |= optimizePhiTypes(F);
    547 
    548     if (MadeChange)
    549       eliminateFallThrough(F);
    550 
    551     // Really free removed instructions during promotion.
    552     for (Instruction *I : RemovedInsts)
    553       I->deleteValue();
    554 
    555     EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
    556     SeenChainsForSExt.clear();
    557     ValToSExtendedUses.clear();
    558     RemovedInsts.clear();
    559     LargeOffsetGEPMap.clear();
    560     LargeOffsetGEPID.clear();
    561   }
    562 
    563   NewGEPBases.clear();
    564   SunkAddrs.clear();
    565 
    566   if (!DisableBranchOpts) {
    567     MadeChange = false;
    568     // Use a set vector to get deterministic iteration order. The order the
    569     // blocks are removed may affect whether or not PHI nodes in successors
    570     // are removed.
    571     SmallSetVector<BasicBlock*, 8> WorkList;
    572     for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
    573       SmallVector<BasicBlock *, 2> Successors(successors(&BB));
    574       MadeChange |= ConstantFoldTerminator(&BB, true);
    575       if (!MadeChange) continue;
    576 
    577       for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
    578         if (pred_empty(Succ))
    579           WorkList.insert(Succ);
    580     }
    581 
    582     // Delete the dead blocks and any of their dead successors.
    583     MadeChange |= !WorkList.empty();
    584     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
    585       BasicBlock *BB = WorkList.pop_back_val();
    586       SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 2> Successors(successors(BB));
    587 
    588       DeleteDeadBlock(BB);
    589 
    590       for (BasicBlock *Succ : Successors)
    591         if (pred_empty(Succ))
    592           WorkList.insert(Succ);
    593     }
    594 
    595     // Merge pairs of basic blocks with unconditional branches, connected by
    596     // a single edge.
    597     if (EverMadeChange || MadeChange)
    598       MadeChange |= eliminateFallThrough(F);
    599 
    600     EverMadeChange |= MadeChange;
    601   }
    602 
    603   if (!DisableGCOpts) {
    604     SmallVector<GCStatepointInst *, 2> Statepoints;
    605     for (BasicBlock &BB : F)
    606       for (Instruction &I : BB)
    607         if (auto *SP = dyn_cast<GCStatepointInst>(&I))
    608           Statepoints.push_back(SP);
    609     for (auto &I : Statepoints)
    610       EverMadeChange |= simplifyOffsetableRelocate(*I);
    611   }
    612 
    613   // Do this last to clean up use-before-def scenarios introduced by other
    614   // preparatory transforms.
    615   EverMadeChange |= placeDbgValues(F);
    616   EverMadeChange |= placePseudoProbes(F);
    617 
    618 #ifndef NDEBUG
    619   if (VerifyBFIUpdates)
    620     verifyBFIUpdates(F);
    621 #endif
    622 
    623   return EverMadeChange;
    624 }
    625 
    626 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateAssumptions(Function &F) {
    627   bool MadeChange = false;
    628   for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
    629     CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
    630     while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
    631       Instruction *I = &*(CurInstIterator++);
    632       if (auto *Assume = dyn_cast<AssumeInst>(I)) {
    633         MadeChange = true;
    634         Value *Operand = Assume->getOperand(0);
    635         Assume->eraseFromParent();
    636 
    637         resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(&BB, [&]() {
    638           RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(Operand, TLInfo, nullptr);
    639         });
    640       }
    641     }
    642   }
    643   return MadeChange;
    644 }
    645 
    646 /// An instruction is about to be deleted, so remove all references to it in our
    647 /// GEP-tracking data strcutures.
    648 void CodeGenPrepare::removeAllAssertingVHReferences(Value *V) {
    649   LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(V);
    650   NewGEPBases.erase(V);
    651 
    652   auto GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V);
    653   if (!GEP)
    654     return;
    655 
    656   LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
    657 
    658   auto VecI = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(GEP->getPointerOperand());
    659   if (VecI == LargeOffsetGEPMap.end())
    660     return;
    661 
    662   auto &GEPVector = VecI->second;
    663   const auto &I =
    664       llvm::find_if(GEPVector, [=](auto &Elt) { return Elt.first == GEP; });
    665   if (I == GEPVector.end())
    666     return;
    667 
    668   GEPVector.erase(I);
    669   if (GEPVector.empty())
    670     LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(VecI);
    671 }
    672 
    673 // Verify BFI has been updated correctly by recomputing BFI and comparing them.
    674 void LLVM_ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED CodeGenPrepare::verifyBFIUpdates(Function &F) {
    675   DominatorTree NewDT(F);
    676   LoopInfo NewLI(NewDT);
    677   BranchProbabilityInfo NewBPI(F, NewLI, TLInfo);
    678   BlockFrequencyInfo NewBFI(F, NewBPI, NewLI);
    679   NewBFI.verifyMatch(*BFI);
    680 }
    681 
    682 /// Merge basic blocks which are connected by a single edge, where one of the
    683 /// basic blocks has a single successor pointing to the other basic block,
    684 /// which has a single predecessor.
    685 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateFallThrough(Function &F) {
    686   bool Changed = false;
    687   // Scan all of the blocks in the function, except for the entry block.
    688   // Use a temporary array to avoid iterator being invalidated when
    689   // deleting blocks.
    690   SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks;
    691   for (auto &Block : llvm::drop_begin(F))
    692     Blocks.push_back(&Block);
    693 
    694   SmallSet<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Preds;
    695   for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
    696     auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
    697     if (!BB)
    698       continue;
    699     // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial
    700     // edge, just collapse it.
    701     BasicBlock *SinglePred = BB->getSinglePredecessor();
    702 
    703     // Don't merge if BB's address is taken.
    704     if (!SinglePred || SinglePred == BB || BB->hasAddressTaken()) continue;
    705 
    706     BranchInst *Term = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(SinglePred->getTerminator());
    707     if (Term && !Term->isConditional()) {
    708       Changed = true;
    709       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "To merge:\n" << *BB << "\n\n\n");
    710 
    711       // Merge BB into SinglePred and delete it.
    712       MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(BB);
    713       Preds.insert(SinglePred);
    714     }
    715   }
    716 
    717   // (Repeatedly) merging blocks into their predecessors can create redundant
    718   // debug intrinsics.
    719   for (auto &Pred : Preds)
    720     if (auto *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Pred))
    721       RemoveRedundantDbgInstrs(BB);
    722 
    723   return Changed;
    724 }
    725 
    726 /// Find a destination block from BB if BB is mergeable empty block.
    727 BasicBlock *CodeGenPrepare::findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
    728   // If this block doesn't end with an uncond branch, ignore it.
    729   BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
    730   if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional())
    731     return nullptr;
    732 
    733   // If the instruction before the branch (skipping debug info) isn't a phi
    734   // node, then other stuff is happening here.
    735   BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BI->getIterator();
    736   if (BBI != BB->begin()) {
    737     --BBI;
    738     while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI)) {
    739       if (BBI == BB->begin())
    740         break;
    741       --BBI;
    742     }
    743     if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) && !isa<PHINode>(BBI))
    744       return nullptr;
    745   }
    746 
    747   // Do not break infinite loops.
    748   BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
    749   if (DestBB == BB)
    750     return nullptr;
    751 
    752   if (!canMergeBlocks(BB, DestBB))
    753     DestBB = nullptr;
    754 
    755   return DestBB;
    756 }
    757 
    758 /// Eliminate blocks that contain only PHI nodes, debug info directives, and an
    759 /// unconditional branch. Passes before isel (e.g. LSR/loopsimplify) often split
    760 /// edges in ways that are non-optimal for isel. Start by eliminating these
    761 /// blocks so we can split them the way we want them.
    762 bool CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlocks(Function &F) {
    763   SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> Preheaders;
    764   SmallVector<Loop *, 16> LoopList(LI->begin(), LI->end());
    765   while (!LoopList.empty()) {
    766     Loop *L = LoopList.pop_back_val();
    767     llvm::append_range(LoopList, *L);
    768     if (BasicBlock *Preheader = L->getLoopPreheader())
    769       Preheaders.insert(Preheader);
    770   }
    771 
    772   bool MadeChange = false;
    773   // Copy blocks into a temporary array to avoid iterator invalidation issues
    774   // as we remove them.
    775   // Note that this intentionally skips the entry block.
    776   SmallVector<WeakTrackingVH, 16> Blocks;
    777   for (auto &Block : llvm::drop_begin(F))
    778     Blocks.push_back(&Block);
    779 
    780   for (auto &Block : Blocks) {
    781     BasicBlock *BB = cast_or_null<BasicBlock>(Block);
    782     if (!BB)
    783       continue;
    784     BasicBlock *DestBB = findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(BB);
    785     if (!DestBB ||
    786         !isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BB, DestBB, Preheaders.count(BB)))
    787       continue;
    788 
    789     eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BB);
    790     MadeChange = true;
    791   }
    792   return MadeChange;
    793 }
    794 
    795 bool CodeGenPrepare::isMergingEmptyBlockProfitable(BasicBlock *BB,
    796                                                    BasicBlock *DestBB,
    797                                                    bool isPreheader) {
    798   // Do not delete loop preheaders if doing so would create a critical edge.
    799   // Loop preheaders can be good locations to spill registers. If the
    800   // preheader is deleted and we create a critical edge, registers may be
    801   // spilled in the loop body instead.
    802   if (!DisablePreheaderProtect && isPreheader &&
    803       !(BB->getSinglePredecessor() &&
    804         BB->getSinglePredecessor()->getSingleSuccessor()))
    805     return false;
    806 
    807   // Skip merging if the block's successor is also a successor to any callbr
    808   // that leads to this block.
    809   // FIXME: Is this really needed? Is this a correctness issue?
    810   for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
    811     if (auto *CBI = dyn_cast<CallBrInst>((Pred)->getTerminator()))
    812       for (unsigned i = 0, e = CBI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
    813         if (DestBB == CBI->getSuccessor(i))
    814           return false;
    815   }
    816 
    817   // Try to skip merging if the unique predecessor of BB is terminated by a
    818   // switch or indirect branch instruction, and BB is used as an incoming block
    819   // of PHIs in DestBB. In such case, merging BB and DestBB would cause ISel to
    820   // add COPY instructions in the predecessor of BB instead of BB (if it is not
    821   // merged). Note that the critical edge created by merging such blocks wont be
    822   // split in MachineSink because the jump table is not analyzable. By keeping
    823   // such empty block (BB), ISel will place COPY instructions in BB, not in the
    824   // predecessor of BB.
    825   BasicBlock *Pred = BB->getUniquePredecessor();
    826   if (!Pred ||
    827       !(isa<SwitchInst>(Pred->getTerminator()) ||
    828         isa<IndirectBrInst>(Pred->getTerminator())))
    829     return true;
    830 
    831   if (BB->getTerminator() != BB->getFirstNonPHIOrDbg())
    832     return true;
    833 
    834   // We use a simple cost heuristic which determine skipping merging is
    835   // profitable if the cost of skipping merging is less than the cost of
    836   // merging : Cost(skipping merging) < Cost(merging BB), where the
    837   // Cost(skipping merging) is Freq(BB) * (Cost(Copy) + Cost(Branch)), and
    838   // the Cost(merging BB) is Freq(Pred) * Cost(Copy).
    839   // Assuming Cost(Copy) == Cost(Branch), we could simplify it to :
    840   //   Freq(Pred) / Freq(BB) > 2.
    841   // Note that if there are multiple empty blocks sharing the same incoming
    842   // value for the PHIs in the DestBB, we consider them together. In such
    843   // case, Cost(merging BB) will be the sum of their frequencies.
    844 
    845   if (!isa<PHINode>(DestBB->begin()))
    846     return true;
    847 
    848   SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock *, 16> SameIncomingValueBBs;
    849 
    850   // Find all other incoming blocks from which incoming values of all PHIs in
    851   // DestBB are the same as the ones from BB.
    852   for (BasicBlock *DestBBPred : predecessors(DestBB)) {
    853     if (DestBBPred == BB)
    854       continue;
    855 
    856     if (llvm::all_of(DestBB->phis(), [&](const PHINode &DestPN) {
    857           return DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB) ==
    858                  DestPN.getIncomingValueForBlock(DestBBPred);
    859         }))
    860       SameIncomingValueBBs.insert(DestBBPred);
    861   }
    862 
    863   // See if all BB's incoming values are same as the value from Pred. In this
    864   // case, no reason to skip merging because COPYs are expected to be place in
    865   // Pred already.
    866   if (SameIncomingValueBBs.count(Pred))
    867     return true;
    868 
    869   BlockFrequency PredFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(Pred);
    870   BlockFrequency BBFreq = BFI->getBlockFreq(BB);
    871 
    872   for (auto *SameValueBB : SameIncomingValueBBs)
    873     if (SameValueBB->getUniquePredecessor() == Pred &&
    874         DestBB == findDestBlockOfMergeableEmptyBlock(SameValueBB))
    875       BBFreq += BFI->getBlockFreq(SameValueBB);
    876 
    877   return PredFreq.getFrequency() <=
    878          BBFreq.getFrequency() * FreqRatioToSkipMerge;
    879 }
    880 
    881 /// Return true if we can merge BB into DestBB if there is a single
    882 /// unconditional branch between them, and BB contains no other non-phi
    883 /// instructions.
    884 bool CodeGenPrepare::canMergeBlocks(const BasicBlock *BB,
    885                                     const BasicBlock *DestBB) const {
    886   // We only want to eliminate blocks whose phi nodes are used by phi nodes in
    887   // the successor.  If there are more complex condition (e.g. preheaders),
    888   // don't mess around with them.
    889   for (const PHINode &PN : BB->phis()) {
    890     for (const User *U : PN.users()) {
    891       const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
    892       if (UI->getParent() != DestBB || !isa<PHINode>(UI))
    893         return false;
    894       // If User is inside DestBB block and it is a PHINode then check
    895       // incoming value. If incoming value is not from BB then this is
    896       // a complex condition (e.g. preheaders) we want to avoid here.
    897       if (UI->getParent() == DestBB) {
    898         if (const PHINode *UPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UI))
    899           for (unsigned I = 0, E = UPN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
    900             Instruction *Insn = dyn_cast<Instruction>(UPN->getIncomingValue(I));
    901             if (Insn && Insn->getParent() == BB &&
    902                 Insn->getParent() != UPN->getIncomingBlock(I))
    903               return false;
    904           }
    905       }
    906     }
    907   }
    908 
    909   // If BB and DestBB contain any common predecessors, then the phi nodes in BB
    910   // and DestBB may have conflicting incoming values for the block.  If so, we
    911   // can't merge the block.
    912   const PHINode *DestBBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(DestBB->begin());
    913   if (!DestBBPN) return true;  // no conflict.
    914 
    915   // Collect the preds of BB.
    916   SmallPtrSet<const BasicBlock*, 16> BBPreds;
    917   if (const PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
    918     // It is faster to get preds from a PHI than with pred_iterator.
    919     for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
    920       BBPreds.insert(BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
    921   } else {
    922     BBPreds.insert(pred_begin(BB), pred_end(BB));
    923   }
    924 
    925   // Walk the preds of DestBB.
    926   for (unsigned i = 0, e = DestBBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
    927     BasicBlock *Pred = DestBBPN->getIncomingBlock(i);
    928     if (BBPreds.count(Pred)) {   // Common predecessor?
    929       for (const PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
    930         const Value *V1 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
    931         const Value *V2 = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(BB);
    932 
    933         // If V2 is a phi node in BB, look up what the mapped value will be.
    934         if (const PHINode *V2PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V2))
    935           if (V2PN->getParent() == BB)
    936             V2 = V2PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(Pred);
    937 
    938         // If there is a conflict, bail out.
    939         if (V1 != V2) return false;
    940       }
    941     }
    942   }
    943 
    944   return true;
    945 }
    946 
    947 /// Eliminate a basic block that has only phi's and an unconditional branch in
    948 /// it.
    949 void CodeGenPrepare::eliminateMostlyEmptyBlock(BasicBlock *BB) {
    950   BranchInst *BI = cast<BranchInst>(BB->getTerminator());
    951   BasicBlock *DestBB = BI->getSuccessor(0);
    952 
    953   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "MERGING MOSTLY EMPTY BLOCKS - BEFORE:\n"
    954                     << *BB << *DestBB);
    955 
    956   // If the destination block has a single pred, then this is a trivial edge,
    957   // just collapse it.
    958   if (BasicBlock *SinglePred = DestBB->getSinglePredecessor()) {
    959     if (SinglePred != DestBB) {
    960       assert(SinglePred == BB &&
    961              "Single predecessor not the same as predecessor");
    962       // Merge DestBB into SinglePred/BB and delete it.
    963       MergeBlockIntoPredecessor(DestBB);
    964       // Note: BB(=SinglePred) will not be deleted on this path.
    965       // DestBB(=its single successor) is the one that was deleted.
    966       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *SinglePred << "\n\n\n");
    967       return;
    968     }
    969   }
    970 
    971   // Otherwise, we have multiple predecessors of BB.  Update the PHIs in DestBB
    972   // to handle the new incoming edges it is about to have.
    973   for (PHINode &PN : DestBB->phis()) {
    974     // Remove the incoming value for BB, and remember it.
    975     Value *InVal = PN.removeIncomingValue(BB, false);
    976 
    977     // Two options: either the InVal is a phi node defined in BB or it is some
    978     // value that dominates BB.
    979     PHINode *InValPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(InVal);
    980     if (InValPhi && InValPhi->getParent() == BB) {
    981       // Add all of the input values of the input PHI as inputs of this phi.
    982       for (unsigned i = 0, e = InValPhi->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
    983         PN.addIncoming(InValPhi->getIncomingValue(i),
    984                        InValPhi->getIncomingBlock(i));
    985     } else {
    986       // Otherwise, add one instance of the dominating value for each edge that
    987       // we will be adding.
    988       if (PHINode *BBPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(BB->begin())) {
    989         for (unsigned i = 0, e = BBPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
    990           PN.addIncoming(InVal, BBPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
    991       } else {
    992         for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB))
    993           PN.addIncoming(InVal, Pred);
    994       }
    995     }
    996   }
    997 
    998   // The PHIs are now updated, change everything that refers to BB to use
    999   // DestBB and remove BB.
   1000   BB->replaceAllUsesWith(DestBB);
   1001   BB->eraseFromParent();
   1002   ++NumBlocksElim;
   1003 
   1004   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "AFTER:\n" << *DestBB << "\n\n\n");
   1005 }
   1006 
   1007 // Computes a map of base pointer relocation instructions to corresponding
   1008 // derived pointer relocation instructions given a vector of all relocate calls
   1009 static void computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(
   1010     const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &AllRelocateCalls,
   1011     DenseMap<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 2>>
   1012         &RelocateInstMap) {
   1013   // Collect information in two maps: one primarily for locating the base object
   1014   // while filling the second map; the second map is the final structure holding
   1015   // a mapping between Base and corresponding Derived relocate calls
   1016   DenseMap<std::pair<unsigned, unsigned>, GCRelocateInst *> RelocateIdxMap;
   1017   for (auto *ThisRelocate : AllRelocateCalls) {
   1018     auto K = std::make_pair(ThisRelocate->getBasePtrIndex(),
   1019                             ThisRelocate->getDerivedPtrIndex());
   1020     RelocateIdxMap.insert(std::make_pair(K, ThisRelocate));
   1021   }
   1022   for (auto &Item : RelocateIdxMap) {
   1023     std::pair<unsigned, unsigned> Key = Item.first;
   1024     if (Key.first == Key.second)
   1025       // Base relocation: nothing to insert
   1026       continue;
   1027 
   1028     GCRelocateInst *I = Item.second;
   1029     auto BaseKey = std::make_pair(Key.first, Key.first);
   1030 
   1031     // We're iterating over RelocateIdxMap so we cannot modify it.
   1032     auto MaybeBase = RelocateIdxMap.find(BaseKey);
   1033     if (MaybeBase == RelocateIdxMap.end())
   1034       // TODO: We might want to insert a new base object relocate and gep off
   1035       // that, if there are enough derived object relocates.
   1036       continue;
   1037 
   1038     RelocateInstMap[MaybeBase->second].push_back(I);
   1039   }
   1040 }
   1041 
   1042 // Accepts a GEP and extracts the operands into a vector provided they're all
   1043 // small integer constants
   1044 static bool getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(GetElementPtrInst *GEP,
   1045                                           SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &OffsetV) {
   1046   for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++) {
   1047     // Only accept small constant integer operands
   1048     auto *Op = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
   1049     if (!Op || Op->getZExtValue() > 20)
   1050       return false;
   1051   }
   1052 
   1053   for (unsigned i = 1; i < GEP->getNumOperands(); i++)
   1054     OffsetV.push_back(GEP->getOperand(i));
   1055   return true;
   1056 }
   1057 
   1058 // Takes a RelocatedBase (base pointer relocation instruction) and Targets to
   1059 // replace, computes a replacement, and affects it.
   1060 static bool
   1061 simplifyRelocatesOffABase(GCRelocateInst *RelocatedBase,
   1062                           const SmallVectorImpl<GCRelocateInst *> &Targets) {
   1063   bool MadeChange = false;
   1064   // We must ensure the relocation of derived pointer is defined after
   1065   // relocation of base pointer. If we find a relocation corresponding to base
   1066   // defined earlier than relocation of base then we move relocation of base
   1067   // right before found relocation. We consider only relocation in the same
   1068   // basic block as relocation of base. Relocations from other basic block will
   1069   // be skipped by optimization and we do not care about them.
   1070   for (auto R = RelocatedBase->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1071        &*R != RelocatedBase; ++R)
   1072     if (auto *RI = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(R))
   1073       if (RI->getStatepoint() == RelocatedBase->getStatepoint())
   1074         if (RI->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex()) {
   1075           RelocatedBase->moveBefore(RI);
   1076           break;
   1077         }
   1078 
   1079   for (GCRelocateInst *ToReplace : Targets) {
   1080     assert(ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == RelocatedBase->getBasePtrIndex() &&
   1081            "Not relocating a derived object of the original base object");
   1082     if (ToReplace->getBasePtrIndex() == ToReplace->getDerivedPtrIndex()) {
   1083       // A duplicate relocate call. TODO: coalesce duplicates.
   1084       continue;
   1085     }
   1086 
   1087     if (RelocatedBase->getParent() != ToReplace->getParent()) {
   1088       // Base and derived relocates are in different basic blocks.
   1089       // In this case transform is only valid when base dominates derived
   1090       // relocate. However it would be too expensive to check dominance
   1091       // for each such relocate, so we skip the whole transformation.
   1092       continue;
   1093     }
   1094 
   1095     Value *Base = ToReplace->getBasePtr();
   1096     auto *Derived = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(ToReplace->getDerivedPtr());
   1097     if (!Derived || Derived->getPointerOperand() != Base)
   1098       continue;
   1099 
   1100     SmallVector<Value *, 2> OffsetV;
   1101     if (!getGEPSmallConstantIntOffsetV(Derived, OffsetV))
   1102       continue;
   1103 
   1104     // Create a Builder and replace the target callsite with a gep
   1105     assert(RelocatedBase->getNextNode() &&
   1106            "Should always have one since it's not a terminator");
   1107 
   1108     // Insert after RelocatedBase
   1109     IRBuilder<> Builder(RelocatedBase->getNextNode());
   1110     Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(ToReplace->getDebugLoc());
   1111 
   1112     // If gc_relocate does not match the actual type, cast it to the right type.
   1113     // In theory, there must be a bitcast after gc_relocate if the type does not
   1114     // match, and we should reuse it to get the derived pointer. But it could be
   1115     // cases like this:
   1116     // bb1:
   1117     //  ...
   1118     //  %g1 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)* @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...)
   1119     //  br label %merge
   1120     //
   1121     // bb2:
   1122     //  ...
   1123     //  %g2 = call coldcc i8 addrspace(1)* @llvm.experimental.gc.relocate.p1i8(...)
   1124     //  br label %merge
   1125     //
   1126     // merge:
   1127     //  %p1 = phi i8 addrspace(1)* [ %g1, %bb1 ], [ %g2, %bb2 ]
   1128     //  %cast = bitcast i8 addrspace(1)* %p1 in to i32 addrspace(1)*
   1129     //
   1130     // In this case, we can not find the bitcast any more. So we insert a new bitcast
   1131     // no matter there is already one or not. In this way, we can handle all cases, and
   1132     // the extra bitcast should be optimized away in later passes.
   1133     Value *ActualRelocatedBase = RelocatedBase;
   1134     if (RelocatedBase->getType() != Base->getType()) {
   1135       ActualRelocatedBase =
   1136           Builder.CreateBitCast(RelocatedBase, Base->getType());
   1137     }
   1138     Value *Replacement = Builder.CreateGEP(
   1139         Derived->getSourceElementType(), ActualRelocatedBase, makeArrayRef(OffsetV));
   1140     Replacement->takeName(ToReplace);
   1141     // If the newly generated derived pointer's type does not match the original derived
   1142     // pointer's type, cast the new derived pointer to match it. Same reasoning as above.
   1143     Value *ActualReplacement = Replacement;
   1144     if (Replacement->getType() != ToReplace->getType()) {
   1145       ActualReplacement =
   1146           Builder.CreateBitCast(Replacement, ToReplace->getType());
   1147     }
   1148     ToReplace->replaceAllUsesWith(ActualReplacement);
   1149     ToReplace->eraseFromParent();
   1150 
   1151     MadeChange = true;
   1152   }
   1153   return MadeChange;
   1154 }
   1155 
   1156 // Turns this:
   1157 //
   1158 // %base = ...
   1159 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
   1160 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
   1161 // %base' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
   1162 // %ptr' = relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 5)
   1163 // %val = load %ptr'
   1164 //
   1165 // into this:
   1166 //
   1167 // %base = ...
   1168 // %ptr = gep %base + 15
   1169 // %tok = statepoint (%fun, i32 0, i32 0, i32 0, %base, %ptr)
   1170 // %base' = gc.relocate(%tok, i32 4, i32 4)
   1171 // %ptr' = gep %base' + 15
   1172 // %val = load %ptr'
   1173 bool CodeGenPrepare::simplifyOffsetableRelocate(GCStatepointInst &I) {
   1174   bool MadeChange = false;
   1175   SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 2> AllRelocateCalls;
   1176   for (auto *U : I.users())
   1177     if (GCRelocateInst *Relocate = dyn_cast<GCRelocateInst>(U))
   1178       // Collect all the relocate calls associated with a statepoint
   1179       AllRelocateCalls.push_back(Relocate);
   1180 
   1181   // We need at least one base pointer relocation + one derived pointer
   1182   // relocation to mangle
   1183   if (AllRelocateCalls.size() < 2)
   1184     return false;
   1185 
   1186   // RelocateInstMap is a mapping from the base relocate instruction to the
   1187   // corresponding derived relocate instructions
   1188   DenseMap<GCRelocateInst *, SmallVector<GCRelocateInst *, 2>> RelocateInstMap;
   1189   computeBaseDerivedRelocateMap(AllRelocateCalls, RelocateInstMap);
   1190   if (RelocateInstMap.empty())
   1191     return false;
   1192 
   1193   for (auto &Item : RelocateInstMap)
   1194     // Item.first is the RelocatedBase to offset against
   1195     // Item.second is the vector of Targets to replace
   1196     MadeChange = simplifyRelocatesOffABase(Item.first, Item.second);
   1197   return MadeChange;
   1198 }
   1199 
   1200 /// Sink the specified cast instruction into its user blocks.
   1201 static bool SinkCast(CastInst *CI) {
   1202   BasicBlock *DefBB = CI->getParent();
   1203 
   1204   /// InsertedCasts - Only insert a cast in each block once.
   1205   DenseMap<BasicBlock*, CastInst*> InsertedCasts;
   1206 
   1207   bool MadeChange = false;
   1208   for (Value::user_iterator UI = CI->user_begin(), E = CI->user_end();
   1209        UI != E; ) {
   1210     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
   1211     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
   1212 
   1213     // Figure out which BB this cast is used in.  For PHI's this is the
   1214     // appropriate predecessor block.
   1215     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
   1216     if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(User)) {
   1217       UserBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(TheUse);
   1218     }
   1219 
   1220     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
   1221     ++UI;
   1222 
   1223     // The first insertion point of a block containing an EH pad is after the
   1224     // pad.  If the pad is the user, we cannot sink the cast past the pad.
   1225     if (User->isEHPad())
   1226       continue;
   1227 
   1228     // If the block selected to receive the cast is an EH pad that does not
   1229     // allow non-PHI instructions before the terminator, we can't sink the
   1230     // cast.
   1231     if (UserBB->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
   1232       continue;
   1233 
   1234     // If this user is in the same block as the cast, don't change the cast.
   1235     if (UserBB == DefBB) continue;
   1236 
   1237     // If we have already inserted a cast into this block, use it.
   1238     CastInst *&InsertedCast = InsertedCasts[UserBB];
   1239 
   1240     if (!InsertedCast) {
   1241       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1242       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
   1243       InsertedCast = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getOperand(0),
   1244                                       CI->getType(), "", &*InsertPt);
   1245       InsertedCast->setDebugLoc(CI->getDebugLoc());
   1246     }
   1247 
   1248     // Replace a use of the cast with a use of the new cast.
   1249     TheUse = InsertedCast;
   1250     MadeChange = true;
   1251     ++NumCastUses;
   1252   }
   1253 
   1254   // If we removed all uses, nuke the cast.
   1255   if (CI->use_empty()) {
   1256     salvageDebugInfo(*CI);
   1257     CI->eraseFromParent();
   1258     MadeChange = true;
   1259   }
   1260 
   1261   return MadeChange;
   1262 }
   1263 
   1264 /// If the specified cast instruction is a noop copy (e.g. it's casting from
   1265 /// one pointer type to another, i32->i8 on PPC), sink it into user blocks to
   1266 /// reduce the number of virtual registers that must be created and coalesced.
   1267 ///
   1268 /// Return true if any changes are made.
   1269 static bool OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CastInst *CI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
   1270                                        const DataLayout &DL) {
   1271   // Sink only "cheap" (or nop) address-space casts.  This is a weaker condition
   1272   // than sinking only nop casts, but is helpful on some platforms.
   1273   if (auto *ASC = dyn_cast<AddrSpaceCastInst>(CI)) {
   1274     if (!TLI.isFreeAddrSpaceCast(ASC->getSrcAddressSpace(),
   1275                                  ASC->getDestAddressSpace()))
   1276       return false;
   1277   }
   1278 
   1279   // If this is a noop copy,
   1280   EVT SrcVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getOperand(0)->getType());
   1281   EVT DstVT = TLI.getValueType(DL, CI->getType());
   1282 
   1283   // This is an fp<->int conversion?
   1284   if (SrcVT.isInteger() != DstVT.isInteger())
   1285     return false;
   1286 
   1287   // If this is an extension, it will be a zero or sign extension, which
   1288   // isn't a noop.
   1289   if (SrcVT.bitsLT(DstVT)) return false;
   1290 
   1291   // If these values will be promoted, find out what they will be promoted
   1292   // to.  This helps us consider truncates on PPC as noop copies when they
   1293   // are.
   1294   if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), SrcVT) ==
   1295       TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
   1296     SrcVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), SrcVT);
   1297   if (TLI.getTypeAction(CI->getContext(), DstVT) ==
   1298       TargetLowering::TypePromoteInteger)
   1299     DstVT = TLI.getTypeToTransformTo(CI->getContext(), DstVT);
   1300 
   1301   // If, after promotion, these are the same types, this is a noop copy.
   1302   if (SrcVT != DstVT)
   1303     return false;
   1304 
   1305   return SinkCast(CI);
   1306 }
   1307 
   1308 // Match a simple increment by constant operation.  Note that if a sub is
   1309 // matched, the step is negated (as if the step had been canonicalized to
   1310 // an add, even though we leave the instruction alone.)
   1311 bool matchIncrement(const Instruction* IVInc, Instruction *&LHS,
   1312                     Constant *&Step) {
   1313   if (match(IVInc, m_Add(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
   1314       match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow>(
   1315                        m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step)))))
   1316     return true;
   1317   if (match(IVInc, m_Sub(m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))) ||
   1318       match(IVInc, m_ExtractValue<0>(m_Intrinsic<Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow>(
   1319                        m_Instruction(LHS), m_Constant(Step))))) {
   1320     Step = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Step);
   1321     return true;
   1322   }
   1323   return false;
   1324 }
   1325 
   1326 /// If given \p PN is an inductive variable with value IVInc coming from the
   1327 /// backedge, and on each iteration it gets increased by Step, return pair
   1328 /// <IVInc, Step>. Otherwise, return None.
   1329 static Optional<std::pair<Instruction *, Constant *> >
   1330 getIVIncrement(const PHINode *PN, const LoopInfo *LI) {
   1331   const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(PN->getParent());
   1332   if (!L || L->getHeader() != PN->getParent() || !L->getLoopLatch())
   1333     return None;
   1334   auto *IVInc =
   1335       dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN->getIncomingValueForBlock(L->getLoopLatch()));
   1336   if (!IVInc || LI->getLoopFor(IVInc->getParent()) != L)
   1337     return None;
   1338   Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
   1339   Constant *Step = nullptr;
   1340   if (matchIncrement(IVInc, LHS, Step) && LHS == PN)
   1341     return std::make_pair(IVInc, Step);
   1342   return None;
   1343 }
   1344 
   1345 static bool isIVIncrement(const Value *V, const LoopInfo *LI) {
   1346   auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
   1347   if (!I)
   1348     return false;
   1349   Instruction *LHS = nullptr;
   1350   Constant *Step = nullptr;
   1351   if (!matchIncrement(I, LHS, Step))
   1352     return false;
   1353   if (auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(LHS))
   1354     if (auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, LI))
   1355       return IVInc->first == I;
   1356   return false;
   1357 }
   1358 
   1359 bool CodeGenPrepare::replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(BinaryOperator *BO,
   1360                                                  Value *Arg0, Value *Arg1,
   1361                                                  CmpInst *Cmp,
   1362                                                  Intrinsic::ID IID) {
   1363   auto IsReplacableIVIncrement = [this, &Cmp](BinaryOperator *BO) {
   1364     if (!isIVIncrement(BO, LI))
   1365       return false;
   1366     const Loop *L = LI->getLoopFor(BO->getParent());
   1367     assert(L && "L should not be null after isIVIncrement()");
   1368     // Do not risk on moving increment into a child loop.
   1369     if (LI->getLoopFor(Cmp->getParent()) != L)
   1370       return false;
   1371 
   1372     // Finally, we need to ensure that the insert point will dominate all
   1373     // existing uses of the increment.
   1374 
   1375     auto &DT = getDT(*BO->getParent()->getParent());
   1376     if (DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), BO->getParent()))
   1377       // If we're moving up the dom tree, all uses are trivially dominated.
   1378       // (This is the common case for code produced by LSR.)
   1379       return true;
   1380 
   1381     // Otherwise, special case the single use in the phi recurrence.
   1382     return BO->hasOneUse() && DT.dominates(Cmp->getParent(), L->getLoopLatch());
   1383   };
   1384   if (BO->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !IsReplacableIVIncrement(BO)) {
   1385     // We used to use a dominator tree here to allow multi-block optimization.
   1386     // But that was problematic because:
   1387     // 1. It could cause a perf regression by hoisting the math op into the
   1388     //    critical path.
   1389     // 2. It could cause a perf regression by creating a value that was live
   1390     //    across multiple blocks and increasing register pressure.
   1391     // 3. Use of a dominator tree could cause large compile-time regression.
   1392     //    This is because we recompute the DT on every change in the main CGP
   1393     //    run-loop. The recomputing is probably unnecessary in many cases, so if
   1394     //    that was fixed, using a DT here would be ok.
   1395     //
   1396     // There is one important particular case we still want to handle: if BO is
   1397     // the IV increment. Important properties that make it profitable:
   1398     // - We can speculate IV increment anywhere in the loop (as long as the
   1399     //   indvar Phi is its only user);
   1400     // - Upon computing Cmp, we effectively compute something equivalent to the
   1401     //   IV increment (despite it loops differently in the IR). So moving it up
   1402     //   to the cmp point does not really increase register pressure.
   1403     return false;
   1404   }
   1405 
   1406   // We allow matching the canonical IR (add X, C) back to (usubo X, -C).
   1407   if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
   1408       IID == Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow) {
   1409     assert(isa<Constant>(Arg1) && "Unexpected input for usubo");
   1410     Arg1 = ConstantExpr::getNeg(cast<Constant>(Arg1));
   1411   }
   1412 
   1413   // Insert at the first instruction of the pair.
   1414   Instruction *InsertPt = nullptr;
   1415   for (Instruction &Iter : *Cmp->getParent()) {
   1416     // If BO is an XOR, it is not guaranteed that it comes after both inputs to
   1417     // the overflow intrinsic are defined.
   1418     if ((BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor && &Iter == BO) || &Iter == Cmp) {
   1419       InsertPt = &Iter;
   1420       break;
   1421     }
   1422   }
   1423   assert(InsertPt != nullptr && "Parent block did not contain cmp or binop");
   1424 
   1425   IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
   1426   Value *MathOV = Builder.CreateBinaryIntrinsic(IID, Arg0, Arg1);
   1427   if (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::Xor) {
   1428     Value *Math = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 0, "math");
   1429     BO->replaceAllUsesWith(Math);
   1430   } else
   1431     assert(BO->hasOneUse() &&
   1432            "Patterns with XOr should use the BO only in the compare");
   1433   Value *OV = Builder.CreateExtractValue(MathOV, 1, "ov");
   1434   Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(OV);
   1435   Cmp->eraseFromParent();
   1436   BO->eraseFromParent();
   1437   return true;
   1438 }
   1439 
   1440 /// Match special-case patterns that check for unsigned add overflow.
   1441 static bool matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(CmpInst *Cmp,
   1442                                                    BinaryOperator *&Add) {
   1443   // Add = add A, 1; Cmp = icmp eq A,-1 (overflow if A is max val)
   1444   // Add = add A,-1; Cmp = icmp ne A, 0 (overflow if A is non-zero)
   1445   Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
   1446 
   1447   // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
   1448   if (isa<Constant>(A))
   1449     return false;
   1450 
   1451   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
   1452   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_AllOnes()))
   1453     B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
   1454   else if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt()))
   1455     B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), -1);
   1456   else
   1457     return false;
   1458 
   1459   // Check the users of the variable operand of the compare looking for an add
   1460   // with the adjusted constant.
   1461   for (User *U : A->users()) {
   1462     if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
   1463       Add = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
   1464       return true;
   1465     }
   1466   }
   1467   return false;
   1468 }
   1469 
   1470 /// Try to combine the compare into a call to the llvm.uadd.with.overflow
   1471 /// intrinsic. Return true if any changes were made.
   1472 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUAddWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
   1473                                                bool &ModifiedDT) {
   1474   Value *A, *B;
   1475   BinaryOperator *Add;
   1476   if (!match(Cmp, m_UAddWithOverflow(m_Value(A), m_Value(B), m_BinOp(Add)))) {
   1477     if (!matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases(Cmp, Add))
   1478       return false;
   1479     // Set A and B in case we match matchUAddWithOverflowConstantEdgeCases.
   1480     A = Add->getOperand(0);
   1481     B = Add->getOperand(1);
   1482   }
   1483 
   1484   if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::UADDO,
   1485                                  TLI->getValueType(*DL, Add->getType()),
   1486                                  Add->hasNUsesOrMore(2)))
   1487     return false;
   1488 
   1489   // We don't want to move around uses of condition values this late, so we
   1490   // check if it is legal to create the call to the intrinsic in the basic
   1491   // block containing the icmp.
   1492   if (Add->getParent() != Cmp->getParent() && !Add->hasOneUse())
   1493     return false;
   1494 
   1495   if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Add, A, B, Cmp,
   1496                                    Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow))
   1497     return false;
   1498 
   1499   // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
   1500   ModifiedDT = true;
   1501   return true;
   1502 }
   1503 
   1504 bool CodeGenPrepare::combineToUSubWithOverflow(CmpInst *Cmp,
   1505                                                bool &ModifiedDT) {
   1506   // We are not expecting non-canonical/degenerate code. Just bail out.
   1507   Value *A = Cmp->getOperand(0), *B = Cmp->getOperand(1);
   1508   if (isa<Constant>(A) && isa<Constant>(B))
   1509     return false;
   1510 
   1511   // Convert (A u> B) to (A u< B) to simplify pattern matching.
   1512   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
   1513   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT) {
   1514     std::swap(A, B);
   1515     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
   1516   }
   1517   // Convert special-case: (A == 0) is the same as (A u< 1).
   1518   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
   1519     B = ConstantInt::get(B->getType(), 1);
   1520     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
   1521   }
   1522   // Convert special-case: (A != 0) is the same as (0 u< A).
   1523   if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && match(B, m_ZeroInt())) {
   1524     std::swap(A, B);
   1525     Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
   1526   }
   1527   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT)
   1528     return false;
   1529 
   1530   // Walk the users of a variable operand of a compare looking for a subtract or
   1531   // add with that same operand. Also match the 2nd operand of the compare to
   1532   // the add/sub, but that may be a negated constant operand of an add.
   1533   Value *CmpVariableOperand = isa<Constant>(A) ? B : A;
   1534   BinaryOperator *Sub = nullptr;
   1535   for (User *U : CmpVariableOperand->users()) {
   1536     // A - B, A u< B --> usubo(A, B)
   1537     if (match(U, m_Sub(m_Specific(A), m_Specific(B)))) {
   1538       Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
   1539       break;
   1540     }
   1541 
   1542     // A + (-C), A u< C (canonicalized form of (sub A, C))
   1543     const APInt *CmpC, *AddC;
   1544     if (match(U, m_Add(m_Specific(A), m_APInt(AddC))) &&
   1545         match(B, m_APInt(CmpC)) && *AddC == -(*CmpC)) {
   1546       Sub = cast<BinaryOperator>(U);
   1547       break;
   1548     }
   1549   }
   1550   if (!Sub)
   1551     return false;
   1552 
   1553   if (!TLI->shouldFormOverflowOp(ISD::USUBO,
   1554                                  TLI->getValueType(*DL, Sub->getType()),
   1555                                  Sub->hasNUsesOrMore(2)))
   1556     return false;
   1557 
   1558   if (!replaceMathCmpWithIntrinsic(Sub, Sub->getOperand(0), Sub->getOperand(1),
   1559                                    Cmp, Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow))
   1560     return false;
   1561 
   1562   // Reset callers - do not crash by iterating over a dead instruction.
   1563   ModifiedDT = true;
   1564   return true;
   1565 }
   1566 
   1567 /// Sink the given CmpInst into user blocks to reduce the number of virtual
   1568 /// registers that must be created and coalesced. This is a clear win except on
   1569 /// targets with multiple condition code registers (PowerPC), where it might
   1570 /// lose; some adjustment may be wanted there.
   1571 ///
   1572 /// Return true if any changes are made.
   1573 static bool sinkCmpExpression(CmpInst *Cmp, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   1574   if (TLI.hasMultipleConditionRegisters())
   1575     return false;
   1576 
   1577   // Avoid sinking soft-FP comparisons, since this can move them into a loop.
   1578   if (TLI.useSoftFloat() && isa<FCmpInst>(Cmp))
   1579     return false;
   1580 
   1581   // Only insert a cmp in each block once.
   1582   DenseMap<BasicBlock*, CmpInst*> InsertedCmps;
   1583 
   1584   bool MadeChange = false;
   1585   for (Value::user_iterator UI = Cmp->user_begin(), E = Cmp->user_end();
   1586        UI != E; ) {
   1587     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
   1588     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
   1589 
   1590     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
   1591     ++UI;
   1592 
   1593     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
   1594     if (isa<PHINode>(User))
   1595       continue;
   1596 
   1597     // Figure out which BB this cmp is used in.
   1598     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
   1599     BasicBlock *DefBB = Cmp->getParent();
   1600 
   1601     // If this user is in the same block as the cmp, don't change the cmp.
   1602     if (UserBB == DefBB) continue;
   1603 
   1604     // If we have already inserted a cmp into this block, use it.
   1605     CmpInst *&InsertedCmp = InsertedCmps[UserBB];
   1606 
   1607     if (!InsertedCmp) {
   1608       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1609       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
   1610       InsertedCmp =
   1611           CmpInst::Create(Cmp->getOpcode(), Cmp->getPredicate(),
   1612                           Cmp->getOperand(0), Cmp->getOperand(1), "",
   1613                           &*InsertPt);
   1614       // Propagate the debug info.
   1615       InsertedCmp->setDebugLoc(Cmp->getDebugLoc());
   1616     }
   1617 
   1618     // Replace a use of the cmp with a use of the new cmp.
   1619     TheUse = InsertedCmp;
   1620     MadeChange = true;
   1621     ++NumCmpUses;
   1622   }
   1623 
   1624   // If we removed all uses, nuke the cmp.
   1625   if (Cmp->use_empty()) {
   1626     Cmp->eraseFromParent();
   1627     MadeChange = true;
   1628   }
   1629 
   1630   return MadeChange;
   1631 }
   1632 
   1633 /// For pattern like:
   1634 ///
   1635 ///   DomCond = icmp sgt/slt CmpOp0, CmpOp1 (might not be in DomBB)
   1636 ///   ...
   1637 /// DomBB:
   1638 ///   ...
   1639 ///   br DomCond, TrueBB, CmpBB
   1640 /// CmpBB: (with DomBB being the single predecessor)
   1641 ///   ...
   1642 ///   Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1
   1643 ///   ...
   1644 ///
   1645 /// It would use two comparison on targets that lowering of icmp sgt/slt is
   1646 /// different from lowering of icmp eq (PowerPC). This function try to convert
   1647 /// 'Cmp = icmp eq CmpOp0, CmpOp1' to ' Cmp = icmp slt/sgt CmpOp0, CmpOp1'.
   1648 /// After that, DomCond and Cmp can use the same comparison so reduce one
   1649 /// comparison.
   1650 ///
   1651 /// Return true if any changes are made.
   1652 static bool foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(CmpInst *Cmp,
   1653                                        const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   1654   if (!EnableICMP_EQToICMP_ST && TLI.isEqualityCmpFoldedWithSignedCmp())
   1655     return false;
   1656 
   1657   ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = Cmp->getPredicate();
   1658   if (Pred != ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
   1659     return false;
   1660 
   1661   // If icmp eq has users other than BranchInst and SelectInst, converting it to
   1662   // icmp slt/sgt would introduce more redundant LLVM IR.
   1663   for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
   1664     if (isa<BranchInst>(U))
   1665       continue;
   1666     if (isa<SelectInst>(U) && cast<SelectInst>(U)->getCondition() == Cmp)
   1667       continue;
   1668     return false;
   1669   }
   1670 
   1671   // This is a cheap/incomplete check for dominance - just match a single
   1672   // predecessor with a conditional branch.
   1673   BasicBlock *CmpBB = Cmp->getParent();
   1674   BasicBlock *DomBB = CmpBB->getSinglePredecessor();
   1675   if (!DomBB)
   1676     return false;
   1677 
   1678   // We want to ensure that the only way control gets to the comparison of
   1679   // interest is that a less/greater than comparison on the same operands is
   1680   // false.
   1681   Value *DomCond;
   1682   BasicBlock *TrueBB, *FalseBB;
   1683   if (!match(DomBB->getTerminator(), m_Br(m_Value(DomCond), TrueBB, FalseBB)))
   1684     return false;
   1685   if (CmpBB != FalseBB)
   1686     return false;
   1687 
   1688   Value *CmpOp0 = Cmp->getOperand(0), *CmpOp1 = Cmp->getOperand(1);
   1689   ICmpInst::Predicate DomPred;
   1690   if (!match(DomCond, m_ICmp(DomPred, m_Specific(CmpOp0), m_Specific(CmpOp1))))
   1691     return false;
   1692   if (DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && DomPred != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
   1693     return false;
   1694 
   1695   // Convert the equality comparison to the opposite of the dominating
   1696   // comparison and swap the direction for all branch/select users.
   1697   // We have conceptually converted:
   1698   // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a == b) ? <EQ_RES> : <GT_RES>;
   1699   // to
   1700   // Res = (a < b) ? <LT_RES> : (a > b)  ? <GT_RES> : <EQ_RES>;
   1701   // And similarly for branches.
   1702   for (User *U : Cmp->users()) {
   1703     if (auto *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(U)) {
   1704       assert(BI->isConditional() && "Must be conditional");
   1705       BI->swapSuccessors();
   1706       continue;
   1707     }
   1708     if (auto *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(U)) {
   1709       // Swap operands
   1710       SI->swapValues();
   1711       SI->swapProfMetadata();
   1712       continue;
   1713     }
   1714     llvm_unreachable("Must be a branch or a select");
   1715   }
   1716   Cmp->setPredicate(CmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(DomPred));
   1717   return true;
   1718 }
   1719 
   1720 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCmp(CmpInst *Cmp, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   1721   if (sinkCmpExpression(Cmp, *TLI))
   1722     return true;
   1723 
   1724   if (combineToUAddWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
   1725     return true;
   1726 
   1727   if (combineToUSubWithOverflow(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
   1728     return true;
   1729 
   1730   if (foldICmpWithDominatingICmp(Cmp, *TLI))
   1731     return true;
   1732 
   1733   return false;
   1734 }
   1735 
   1736 /// Duplicate and sink the given 'and' instruction into user blocks where it is
   1737 /// used in a compare to allow isel to generate better code for targets where
   1738 /// this operation can be combined.
   1739 ///
   1740 /// Return true if any changes are made.
   1741 static bool sinkAndCmp0Expression(Instruction *AndI,
   1742                                   const TargetLowering &TLI,
   1743                                   SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts) {
   1744   // Double-check that we're not trying to optimize an instruction that was
   1745   // already optimized by some other part of this pass.
   1746   assert(!InsertedInsts.count(AndI) &&
   1747          "Attempting to optimize already optimized and instruction");
   1748   (void) InsertedInsts;
   1749 
   1750   // Nothing to do for single use in same basic block.
   1751   if (AndI->hasOneUse() &&
   1752       AndI->getParent() == cast<Instruction>(*AndI->user_begin())->getParent())
   1753     return false;
   1754 
   1755   // Try to avoid cases where sinking/duplicating is likely to increase register
   1756   // pressure.
   1757   if (!isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(0)) &&
   1758       !isa<ConstantInt>(AndI->getOperand(1)) &&
   1759       AndI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && AndI->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse())
   1760     return false;
   1761 
   1762   for (auto *U : AndI->users()) {
   1763     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U);
   1764 
   1765     // Only sink 'and' feeding icmp with 0.
   1766     if (!isa<ICmpInst>(User))
   1767       return false;
   1768 
   1769     auto *CmpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1));
   1770     if (!CmpC || !CmpC->isZero())
   1771       return false;
   1772   }
   1773 
   1774   if (!TLI.isMaskAndCmp0FoldingBeneficial(*AndI))
   1775     return false;
   1776 
   1777   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "found 'and' feeding only icmp 0;\n");
   1778   LLVM_DEBUG(AndI->getParent()->dump());
   1779 
   1780   // Push the 'and' into the same block as the icmp 0.  There should only be
   1781   // one (icmp (and, 0)) in each block, since CSE/GVN should have removed any
   1782   // others, so we don't need to keep track of which BBs we insert into.
   1783   for (Value::user_iterator UI = AndI->user_begin(), E = AndI->user_end();
   1784        UI != E; ) {
   1785     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
   1786     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
   1787 
   1788     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
   1789     ++UI;
   1790 
   1791     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "sinking 'and' use: " << *User << "\n");
   1792 
   1793     // Keep the 'and' in the same place if the use is already in the same block.
   1794     Instruction *InsertPt =
   1795         User->getParent() == AndI->getParent() ? AndI : User;
   1796     Instruction *InsertedAnd =
   1797         BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::And, AndI->getOperand(0),
   1798                                AndI->getOperand(1), "", InsertPt);
   1799     // Propagate the debug info.
   1800     InsertedAnd->setDebugLoc(AndI->getDebugLoc());
   1801 
   1802     // Replace a use of the 'and' with a use of the new 'and'.
   1803     TheUse = InsertedAnd;
   1804     ++NumAndUses;
   1805     LLVM_DEBUG(User->getParent()->dump());
   1806   }
   1807 
   1808   // We removed all uses, nuke the and.
   1809   AndI->eraseFromParent();
   1810   return true;
   1811 }
   1812 
   1813 /// Check if the candidates could be combined with a shift instruction, which
   1814 /// includes:
   1815 /// 1. Truncate instruction
   1816 /// 2. And instruction and the imm is a mask of the low bits:
   1817 /// imm & (imm+1) == 0
   1818 static bool isExtractBitsCandidateUse(Instruction *User) {
   1819   if (!isa<TruncInst>(User)) {
   1820     if (User->getOpcode() != Instruction::And ||
   1821         !isa<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1)))
   1822       return false;
   1823 
   1824     const APInt &Cimm = cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1))->getValue();
   1825 
   1826     if ((Cimm & (Cimm + 1)).getBoolValue())
   1827       return false;
   1828   }
   1829   return true;
   1830 }
   1831 
   1832 /// Sink both shift and truncate instruction to the use of truncate's BB.
   1833 static bool
   1834 SinkShiftAndTruncate(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, Instruction *User, ConstantInt *CI,
   1835                      DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> &InsertedShifts,
   1836                      const TargetLowering &TLI, const DataLayout &DL) {
   1837   BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
   1838   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, CastInst *> InsertedTruncs;
   1839   auto *TruncI = cast<TruncInst>(User);
   1840   bool MadeChange = false;
   1841 
   1842   for (Value::user_iterator TruncUI = TruncI->user_begin(),
   1843                             TruncE = TruncI->user_end();
   1844        TruncUI != TruncE;) {
   1845 
   1846     Use &TruncTheUse = TruncUI.getUse();
   1847     Instruction *TruncUser = cast<Instruction>(*TruncUI);
   1848     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
   1849 
   1850     ++TruncUI;
   1851 
   1852     int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(TruncUser->getOpcode());
   1853     if (!ISDOpcode)
   1854       continue;
   1855 
   1856     // If the use is actually a legal node, there will not be an
   1857     // implicit truncate.
   1858     // FIXME: always querying the result type is just an
   1859     // approximation; some nodes' legality is determined by the
   1860     // operand or other means. There's no good way to find out though.
   1861     if (TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
   1862             ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, TruncUser->getType(), true)))
   1863       continue;
   1864 
   1865     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
   1866     if (isa<PHINode>(TruncUser))
   1867       continue;
   1868 
   1869     BasicBlock *TruncUserBB = TruncUser->getParent();
   1870 
   1871     if (UserBB == TruncUserBB)
   1872       continue;
   1873 
   1874     BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[TruncUserBB];
   1875     CastInst *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[TruncUserBB];
   1876 
   1877     if (!InsertedShift && !InsertedTrunc) {
   1878       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1879       assert(InsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
   1880       // Sink the shift
   1881       if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
   1882         InsertedShift = BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI,
   1883                                                    "", &*InsertPt);
   1884       else
   1885         InsertedShift = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI,
   1886                                                    "", &*InsertPt);
   1887       InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
   1888 
   1889       // Sink the trunc
   1890       BasicBlock::iterator TruncInsertPt = TruncUserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1891       TruncInsertPt++;
   1892       assert(TruncInsertPt != TruncUserBB->end());
   1893 
   1894       InsertedTrunc = CastInst::Create(TruncI->getOpcode(), InsertedShift,
   1895                                        TruncI->getType(), "", &*TruncInsertPt);
   1896       InsertedTrunc->setDebugLoc(TruncI->getDebugLoc());
   1897 
   1898       MadeChange = true;
   1899 
   1900       TruncTheUse = InsertedTrunc;
   1901     }
   1902   }
   1903   return MadeChange;
   1904 }
   1905 
   1906 /// Sink the shift *right* instruction into user blocks if the uses could
   1907 /// potentially be combined with this shift instruction and generate BitExtract
   1908 /// instruction. It will only be applied if the architecture supports BitExtract
   1909 /// instruction. Here is an example:
   1910 /// BB1:
   1911 ///   %x.extract.shift = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
   1912 /// BB2:
   1913 ///   %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift to i16
   1914 /// ==>
   1915 ///
   1916 /// BB2:
   1917 ///   %x.extract.shift.1 = lshr i64 %arg1, 32
   1918 ///   %x.extract.trunc = trunc i64 %x.extract.shift.1 to i16
   1919 ///
   1920 /// CodeGen will recognize the pattern in BB2 and generate BitExtract
   1921 /// instruction.
   1922 /// Return true if any changes are made.
   1923 static bool OptimizeExtractBits(BinaryOperator *ShiftI, ConstantInt *CI,
   1924                                 const TargetLowering &TLI,
   1925                                 const DataLayout &DL) {
   1926   BasicBlock *DefBB = ShiftI->getParent();
   1927 
   1928   /// Only insert instructions in each block once.
   1929   DenseMap<BasicBlock *, BinaryOperator *> InsertedShifts;
   1930 
   1931   bool shiftIsLegal = TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, ShiftI->getType()));
   1932 
   1933   bool MadeChange = false;
   1934   for (Value::user_iterator UI = ShiftI->user_begin(), E = ShiftI->user_end();
   1935        UI != E;) {
   1936     Use &TheUse = UI.getUse();
   1937     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
   1938     // Preincrement use iterator so we don't invalidate it.
   1939     ++UI;
   1940 
   1941     // Don't bother for PHI nodes.
   1942     if (isa<PHINode>(User))
   1943       continue;
   1944 
   1945     if (!isExtractBitsCandidateUse(User))
   1946       continue;
   1947 
   1948     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
   1949 
   1950     if (UserBB == DefBB) {
   1951       // If the shift and truncate instruction are in the same BB. The use of
   1952       // the truncate(TruncUse) may still introduce another truncate if not
   1953       // legal. In this case, we would like to sink both shift and truncate
   1954       // instruction to the BB of TruncUse.
   1955       // for example:
   1956       // BB1:
   1957       // i64 shift.result = lshr i64 opnd, imm
   1958       // trunc.result = trunc shift.result to i16
   1959       //
   1960       // BB2:
   1961       //   ----> We will have an implicit truncate here if the architecture does
   1962       //   not have i16 compare.
   1963       // cmp i16 trunc.result, opnd2
   1964       //
   1965       if (isa<TruncInst>(User) && shiftIsLegal
   1966           // If the type of the truncate is legal, no truncate will be
   1967           // introduced in other basic blocks.
   1968           &&
   1969           (!TLI.isTypeLegal(TLI.getValueType(DL, User->getType()))))
   1970         MadeChange =
   1971             SinkShiftAndTruncate(ShiftI, User, CI, InsertedShifts, TLI, DL);
   1972 
   1973       continue;
   1974     }
   1975     // If we have already inserted a shift into this block, use it.
   1976     BinaryOperator *&InsertedShift = InsertedShifts[UserBB];
   1977 
   1978     if (!InsertedShift) {
   1979       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   1980       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
   1981 
   1982       if (ShiftI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
   1983         InsertedShift = BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI,
   1984                                                    "", &*InsertPt);
   1985       else
   1986         InsertedShift = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShiftI->getOperand(0), CI,
   1987                                                    "", &*InsertPt);
   1988       InsertedShift->setDebugLoc(ShiftI->getDebugLoc());
   1989 
   1990       MadeChange = true;
   1991     }
   1992 
   1993     // Replace a use of the shift with a use of the new shift.
   1994     TheUse = InsertedShift;
   1995   }
   1996 
   1997   // If we removed all uses, or there are none, nuke the shift.
   1998   if (ShiftI->use_empty()) {
   1999     salvageDebugInfo(*ShiftI);
   2000     ShiftI->eraseFromParent();
   2001     MadeChange = true;
   2002   }
   2003 
   2004   return MadeChange;
   2005 }
   2006 
   2007 /// If counting leading or trailing zeros is an expensive operation and a zero
   2008 /// input is defined, add a check for zero to avoid calling the intrinsic.
   2009 ///
   2010 /// We want to transform:
   2011 ///     %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 false)
   2012 ///
   2013 /// into:
   2014 ///   entry:
   2015 ///     %cmpz = icmp eq i64 %A, 0
   2016 ///     br i1 %cmpz, label %cond.end, label %cond.false
   2017 ///   cond.false:
   2018 ///     %z = call i64 @llvm.cttz.i64(i64 %A, i1 true)
   2019 ///     br label %cond.end
   2020 ///   cond.end:
   2021 ///     %ctz = phi i64 [ 64, %entry ], [ %z, %cond.false ]
   2022 ///
   2023 /// If the transform is performed, return true and set ModifiedDT to true.
   2024 static bool despeculateCountZeros(IntrinsicInst *CountZeros,
   2025                                   const TargetLowering *TLI,
   2026                                   const DataLayout *DL,
   2027                                   bool &ModifiedDT) {
   2028   // If a zero input is undefined, it doesn't make sense to despeculate that.
   2029   if (match(CountZeros->getOperand(1), m_One()))
   2030     return false;
   2031 
   2032   // If it's cheap to speculate, there's nothing to do.
   2033   auto IntrinsicID = CountZeros->getIntrinsicID();
   2034   if ((IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::cttz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCttz()) ||
   2035       (IntrinsicID == Intrinsic::ctlz && TLI->isCheapToSpeculateCtlz()))
   2036     return false;
   2037 
   2038   // Only handle legal scalar cases. Anything else requires too much work.
   2039   Type *Ty = CountZeros->getType();
   2040   unsigned SizeInBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
   2041   if (Ty->isVectorTy() || SizeInBits > DL->getLargestLegalIntTypeSizeInBits())
   2042     return false;
   2043 
   2044   // The intrinsic will be sunk behind a compare against zero and branch.
   2045   BasicBlock *StartBlock = CountZeros->getParent();
   2046   BasicBlock *CallBlock = StartBlock->splitBasicBlock(CountZeros, "cond.false");
   2047 
   2048   // Create another block after the count zero intrinsic. A PHI will be added
   2049   // in this block to select the result of the intrinsic or the bit-width
   2050   // constant if the input to the intrinsic is zero.
   2051   BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = ++(BasicBlock::iterator(CountZeros));
   2052   BasicBlock *EndBlock = CallBlock->splitBasicBlock(SplitPt, "cond.end");
   2053 
   2054   // Set up a builder to create a compare, conditional branch, and PHI.
   2055   IRBuilder<> Builder(CountZeros->getContext());
   2056   Builder.SetInsertPoint(StartBlock->getTerminator());
   2057   Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(CountZeros->getDebugLoc());
   2058 
   2059   // Replace the unconditional branch that was created by the first split with
   2060   // a compare against zero and a conditional branch.
   2061   Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Ty);
   2062   Value *Cmp = Builder.CreateICmpEQ(CountZeros->getOperand(0), Zero, "cmpz");
   2063   Builder.CreateCondBr(Cmp, EndBlock, CallBlock);
   2064   StartBlock->getTerminator()->eraseFromParent();
   2065 
   2066   // Create a PHI in the end block to select either the output of the intrinsic
   2067   // or the bit width of the operand.
   2068   Builder.SetInsertPoint(&EndBlock->front());
   2069   PHINode *PN = Builder.CreatePHI(Ty, 2, "ctz");
   2070   CountZeros->replaceAllUsesWith(PN);
   2071   Value *BitWidth = Builder.getInt(APInt(SizeInBits, SizeInBits));
   2072   PN->addIncoming(BitWidth, StartBlock);
   2073   PN->addIncoming(CountZeros, CallBlock);
   2074 
   2075   // We are explicitly handling the zero case, so we can set the intrinsic's
   2076   // undefined zero argument to 'true'. This will also prevent reprocessing the
   2077   // intrinsic; we only despeculate when a zero input is defined.
   2078   CountZeros->setArgOperand(1, Builder.getTrue());
   2079   ModifiedDT = true;
   2080   return true;
   2081 }
   2082 
   2083 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeCallInst(CallInst *CI, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   2084   BasicBlock *BB = CI->getParent();
   2085 
   2086   // Lower inline assembly if we can.
   2087   // If we found an inline asm expession, and if the target knows how to
   2088   // lower it to normal LLVM code, do so now.
   2089   if (CI->isInlineAsm()) {
   2090     if (TLI->ExpandInlineAsm(CI)) {
   2091       // Avoid invalidating the iterator.
   2092       CurInstIterator = BB->begin();
   2093       // Avoid processing instructions out of order, which could cause
   2094       // reuse before a value is defined.
   2095       SunkAddrs.clear();
   2096       return true;
   2097     }
   2098     // Sink address computing for memory operands into the block.
   2099     if (optimizeInlineAsmInst(CI))
   2100       return true;
   2101   }
   2102 
   2103   // Align the pointer arguments to this call if the target thinks it's a good
   2104   // idea
   2105   unsigned MinSize, PrefAlign;
   2106   if (TLI->shouldAlignPointerArgs(CI, MinSize, PrefAlign)) {
   2107     for (auto &Arg : CI->arg_operands()) {
   2108       // We want to align both objects whose address is used directly and
   2109       // objects whose address is used in casts and GEPs, though it only makes
   2110       // sense for GEPs if the offset is a multiple of the desired alignment and
   2111       // if size - offset meets the size threshold.
   2112       if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
   2113         continue;
   2114       APInt Offset(DL->getIndexSizeInBits(
   2115                        cast<PointerType>(Arg->getType())->getAddressSpace()),
   2116                    0);
   2117       Value *Val = Arg->stripAndAccumulateInBoundsConstantOffsets(*DL, Offset);
   2118       uint64_t Offset2 = Offset.getLimitedValue();
   2119       if ((Offset2 & (PrefAlign-1)) != 0)
   2120         continue;
   2121       AllocaInst *AI;
   2122       if ((AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val)) && AI->getAlignment() < PrefAlign &&
   2123           DL->getTypeAllocSize(AI->getAllocatedType()) >= MinSize + Offset2)
   2124         AI->setAlignment(Align(PrefAlign));
   2125       // Global variables can only be aligned if they are defined in this
   2126       // object (i.e. they are uniquely initialized in this object), and
   2127       // over-aligning global variables that have an explicit section is
   2128       // forbidden.
   2129       GlobalVariable *GV;
   2130       if ((GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Val)) && GV->canIncreaseAlignment() &&
   2131           GV->getPointerAlignment(*DL) < PrefAlign &&
   2132           DL->getTypeAllocSize(GV->getValueType()) >=
   2133               MinSize + Offset2)
   2134         GV->setAlignment(MaybeAlign(PrefAlign));
   2135     }
   2136     // If this is a memcpy (or similar) then we may be able to improve the
   2137     // alignment
   2138     if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(CI)) {
   2139       Align DestAlign = getKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), *DL);
   2140       MaybeAlign MIDestAlign = MI->getDestAlign();
   2141       if (!MIDestAlign || DestAlign > *MIDestAlign)
   2142         MI->setDestAlignment(DestAlign);
   2143       if (MemTransferInst *MTI = dyn_cast<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
   2144         MaybeAlign MTISrcAlign = MTI->getSourceAlign();
   2145         Align SrcAlign = getKnownAlignment(MTI->getSource(), *DL);
   2146         if (!MTISrcAlign || SrcAlign > *MTISrcAlign)
   2147           MTI->setSourceAlignment(SrcAlign);
   2148       }
   2149     }
   2150   }
   2151 
   2152   // If we have a cold call site, try to sink addressing computation into the
   2153   // cold block.  This interacts with our handling for loads and stores to
   2154   // ensure that we can fold all uses of a potential addressing computation
   2155   // into their uses.  TODO: generalize this to work over profiling data
   2156   if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold) &&
   2157       !OptSize && !llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(BB, PSI, BFI.get()))
   2158     for (auto &Arg : CI->arg_operands()) {
   2159       if (!Arg->getType()->isPointerTy())
   2160         continue;
   2161       unsigned AS = Arg->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
   2162       return optimizeMemoryInst(CI, Arg, Arg->getType(), AS);
   2163     }
   2164 
   2165   IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(CI);
   2166   if (II) {
   2167     switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
   2168     default: break;
   2169     case Intrinsic::assume:
   2170       llvm_unreachable("llvm.assume should have been removed already");
   2171     case Intrinsic::experimental_widenable_condition: {
   2172       // Give up on future widening oppurtunties so that we can fold away dead
   2173       // paths and merge blocks before going into block-local instruction
   2174       // selection.
   2175       if (II->use_empty()) {
   2176         II->eraseFromParent();
   2177         return true;
   2178       }
   2179       Constant *RetVal = ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext());
   2180       resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(BB, [&]() {
   2181         replaceAndRecursivelySimplify(CI, RetVal, TLInfo, nullptr);
   2182       });
   2183       return true;
   2184     }
   2185     case Intrinsic::objectsize:
   2186       llvm_unreachable("llvm.objectsize.* should have been lowered already");
   2187     case Intrinsic::is_constant:
   2188       llvm_unreachable("llvm.is.constant.* should have been lowered already");
   2189     case Intrinsic::aarch64_stlxr:
   2190     case Intrinsic::aarch64_stxr: {
   2191       ZExtInst *ExtVal = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(CI->getArgOperand(0));
   2192       if (!ExtVal || !ExtVal->hasOneUse() ||
   2193           ExtVal->getParent() == CI->getParent())
   2194         return false;
   2195       // Sink a zext feeding stlxr/stxr before it, so it can be folded into it.
   2196       ExtVal->moveBefore(CI);
   2197       // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
   2198       // optimizations don't touch it.
   2199       InsertedInsts.insert(ExtVal);
   2200       return true;
   2201     }
   2202 
   2203     case Intrinsic::launder_invariant_group:
   2204     case Intrinsic::strip_invariant_group: {
   2205       Value *ArgVal = II->getArgOperand(0);
   2206       auto it = LargeOffsetGEPMap.find(II);
   2207       if (it != LargeOffsetGEPMap.end()) {
   2208           // Merge entries in LargeOffsetGEPMap to reflect the RAUW.
   2209           // Make sure not to have to deal with iterator invalidation
   2210           // after possibly adding ArgVal to LargeOffsetGEPMap.
   2211           auto GEPs = std::move(it->second);
   2212           LargeOffsetGEPMap[ArgVal].append(GEPs.begin(), GEPs.end());
   2213           LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(II);
   2214       }
   2215 
   2216       II->replaceAllUsesWith(ArgVal);
   2217       II->eraseFromParent();
   2218       return true;
   2219     }
   2220     case Intrinsic::cttz:
   2221     case Intrinsic::ctlz:
   2222       // If counting zeros is expensive, try to avoid it.
   2223       return despeculateCountZeros(II, TLI, DL, ModifiedDT);
   2224     case Intrinsic::fshl:
   2225     case Intrinsic::fshr:
   2226       return optimizeFunnelShift(II);
   2227     case Intrinsic::dbg_value:
   2228       return fixupDbgValue(II);
   2229     case Intrinsic::vscale: {
   2230       // If datalayout has no special restrictions on vector data layout,
   2231       // replace `llvm.vscale` by an equivalent constant expression
   2232       // to benefit from cheap constant propagation.
   2233       Type *ScalableVectorTy =
   2234           VectorType::get(Type::getInt8Ty(II->getContext()), 1, true);
   2235       if (DL->getTypeAllocSize(ScalableVectorTy).getKnownMinSize() == 8) {
   2236         auto *Null = Constant::getNullValue(ScalableVectorTy->getPointerTo());
   2237         auto *One = ConstantInt::getSigned(II->getType(), 1);
   2238         auto *CGep =
   2239             ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(ScalableVectorTy, Null, One);
   2240         II->replaceAllUsesWith(ConstantExpr::getPtrToInt(CGep, II->getType()));
   2241         II->eraseFromParent();
   2242         return true;
   2243       }
   2244       break;
   2245     }
   2246     case Intrinsic::masked_gather:
   2247       return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(0));
   2248     case Intrinsic::masked_scatter:
   2249       return optimizeGatherScatterInst(II, II->getArgOperand(1));
   2250     }
   2251 
   2252     SmallVector<Value *, 2> PtrOps;
   2253     Type *AccessTy;
   2254     if (TLI->getAddrModeArguments(II, PtrOps, AccessTy))
   2255       while (!PtrOps.empty()) {
   2256         Value *PtrVal = PtrOps.pop_back_val();
   2257         unsigned AS = PtrVal->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
   2258         if (optimizeMemoryInst(II, PtrVal, AccessTy, AS))
   2259           return true;
   2260       }
   2261   }
   2262 
   2263   // From here on out we're working with named functions.
   2264   if (!CI->getCalledFunction()) return false;
   2265 
   2266   // Lower all default uses of _chk calls.  This is very similar
   2267   // to what InstCombineCalls does, but here we are only lowering calls
   2268   // to fortified library functions (e.g. __memcpy_chk) that have the default
   2269   // "don't know" as the objectsize.  Anything else should be left alone.
   2270   FortifiedLibCallSimplifier Simplifier(TLInfo, true);
   2271   IRBuilder<> Builder(CI);
   2272   if (Value *V = Simplifier.optimizeCall(CI, Builder)) {
   2273     CI->replaceAllUsesWith(V);
   2274     CI->eraseFromParent();
   2275     return true;
   2276   }
   2277 
   2278   return false;
   2279 }
   2280 
   2281 /// Look for opportunities to duplicate return instructions to the predecessor
   2282 /// to enable tail call optimizations. The case it is currently looking for is:
   2283 /// @code
   2284 /// bb0:
   2285 ///   %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
   2286 ///   br label %return
   2287 /// bb1:
   2288 ///   %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
   2289 ///   br label %return
   2290 /// bb2:
   2291 ///   %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
   2292 ///   br label %return
   2293 /// return:
   2294 ///   %retval = phi i32 [ %tmp0, %bb0 ], [ %tmp1, %bb1 ], [ %tmp2, %bb2 ]
   2295 ///   ret i32 %retval
   2296 /// @endcode
   2297 ///
   2298 /// =>
   2299 ///
   2300 /// @code
   2301 /// bb0:
   2302 ///   %tmp0 = tail call i32 @f0()
   2303 ///   ret i32 %tmp0
   2304 /// bb1:
   2305 ///   %tmp1 = tail call i32 @f1()
   2306 ///   ret i32 %tmp1
   2307 /// bb2:
   2308 ///   %tmp2 = tail call i32 @f2()
   2309 ///   ret i32 %tmp2
   2310 /// @endcode
   2311 bool CodeGenPrepare::dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(BasicBlock *BB, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   2312   ReturnInst *RetI = dyn_cast<ReturnInst>(BB->getTerminator());
   2313   if (!RetI)
   2314     return false;
   2315 
   2316   PHINode *PN = nullptr;
   2317   ExtractValueInst *EVI = nullptr;
   2318   BitCastInst *BCI = nullptr;
   2319   Value *V = RetI->getReturnValue();
   2320   if (V) {
   2321     BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V);
   2322     if (BCI)
   2323       V = BCI->getOperand(0);
   2324 
   2325     EVI = dyn_cast<ExtractValueInst>(V);
   2326     if (EVI) {
   2327       V = EVI->getOperand(0);
   2328       if (!llvm::all_of(EVI->indices(), [](unsigned idx) { return idx == 0; }))
   2329         return false;
   2330     }
   2331 
   2332     PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
   2333     if (!PN)
   2334       return false;
   2335   }
   2336 
   2337   if (PN && PN->getParent() != BB)
   2338     return false;
   2339 
   2340   auto isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor = [](const Instruction *Inst) {
   2341     const BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Inst);
   2342     if (BC && BC->hasOneUse())
   2343       Inst = BC->user_back();
   2344 
   2345     if (const IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Inst))
   2346       return II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::lifetime_end;
   2347     return false;
   2348   };
   2349 
   2350   // Make sure there are no instructions between the first instruction
   2351   // and return.
   2352   const Instruction *BI = BB->getFirstNonPHI();
   2353   // Skip over debug and the bitcast.
   2354   while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BI) || BI == BCI || BI == EVI ||
   2355          isa<PseudoProbeInst>(BI) || isLifetimeEndOrBitCastFor(BI))
   2356     BI = BI->getNextNode();
   2357   if (BI != RetI)
   2358     return false;
   2359 
   2360   /// Only dup the ReturnInst if the CallInst is likely to be emitted as a tail
   2361   /// call.
   2362   const Function *F = BB->getParent();
   2363   SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 4> TailCallBBs;
   2364   if (PN) {
   2365     for (unsigned I = 0, E = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); I != E; ++I) {
   2366       // Look through bitcasts.
   2367       Value *IncomingVal = PN->getIncomingValue(I)->stripPointerCasts();
   2368       CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(IncomingVal);
   2369       BasicBlock *PredBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(I);
   2370       // Make sure the phi value is indeed produced by the tail call.
   2371       if (CI && CI->hasOneUse() && CI->getParent() == PredBB &&
   2372           TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
   2373           attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI))
   2374         TailCallBBs.push_back(PredBB);
   2375     }
   2376   } else {
   2377     SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 4> VisitedBBs;
   2378     for (BasicBlock *Pred : predecessors(BB)) {
   2379       if (!VisitedBBs.insert(Pred).second)
   2380         continue;
   2381       if (Instruction *I = Pred->rbegin()->getPrevNonDebugInstruction(true)) {
   2382         CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(I);
   2383         if (CI && CI->use_empty() && TLI->mayBeEmittedAsTailCall(CI) &&
   2384             attributesPermitTailCall(F, CI, RetI, *TLI))
   2385           TailCallBBs.push_back(Pred);
   2386       }
   2387     }
   2388   }
   2389 
   2390   bool Changed = false;
   2391   for (auto const &TailCallBB : TailCallBBs) {
   2392     // Make sure the call instruction is followed by an unconditional branch to
   2393     // the return block.
   2394     BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TailCallBB->getTerminator());
   2395     if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional() || BI->getSuccessor(0) != BB)
   2396       continue;
   2397 
   2398     // Duplicate the return into TailCallBB.
   2399     (void)FoldReturnIntoUncondBranch(RetI, BB, TailCallBB);
   2400     assert(!VerifyBFIUpdates ||
   2401            BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) >= BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB));
   2402     BFI->setBlockFreq(
   2403         BB,
   2404         (BFI->getBlockFreq(BB) - BFI->getBlockFreq(TailCallBB)).getFrequency());
   2405     ModifiedDT = Changed = true;
   2406     ++NumRetsDup;
   2407   }
   2408 
   2409   // If we eliminated all predecessors of the block, delete the block now.
   2410   if (Changed && !BB->hasAddressTaken() && pred_empty(BB))
   2411     BB->eraseFromParent();
   2412 
   2413   return Changed;
   2414 }
   2415 
   2416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
   2417 // Memory Optimization
   2418 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
   2419 
   2420 namespace {
   2421 
   2422 /// This is an extended version of TargetLowering::AddrMode
   2423 /// which holds actual Value*'s for register values.
   2424 struct ExtAddrMode : public TargetLowering::AddrMode {
   2425   Value *BaseReg = nullptr;
   2426   Value *ScaledReg = nullptr;
   2427   Value *OriginalValue = nullptr;
   2428   bool InBounds = true;
   2429 
   2430   enum FieldName {
   2431     NoField        = 0x00,
   2432     BaseRegField   = 0x01,
   2433     BaseGVField    = 0x02,
   2434     BaseOffsField  = 0x04,
   2435     ScaledRegField = 0x08,
   2436     ScaleField     = 0x10,
   2437     MultipleFields = 0xff
   2438   };
   2439 
   2440 
   2441   ExtAddrMode() = default;
   2442 
   2443   void print(raw_ostream &OS) const;
   2444   void dump() const;
   2445 
   2446   FieldName compare(const ExtAddrMode &other) {
   2447     // First check that the types are the same on each field, as differing types
   2448     // is something we can't cope with later on.
   2449     if (BaseReg && other.BaseReg &&
   2450         BaseReg->getType() != other.BaseReg->getType())
   2451       return MultipleFields;
   2452     if (BaseGV && other.BaseGV &&
   2453         BaseGV->getType() != other.BaseGV->getType())
   2454       return MultipleFields;
   2455     if (ScaledReg && other.ScaledReg &&
   2456         ScaledReg->getType() != other.ScaledReg->getType())
   2457       return MultipleFields;
   2458 
   2459     // Conservatively reject 'inbounds' mismatches.
   2460     if (InBounds != other.InBounds)
   2461       return MultipleFields;
   2462 
   2463     // Check each field to see if it differs.
   2464     unsigned Result = NoField;
   2465     if (BaseReg != other.BaseReg)
   2466       Result |= BaseRegField;
   2467     if (BaseGV != other.BaseGV)
   2468       Result |= BaseGVField;
   2469     if (BaseOffs != other.BaseOffs)
   2470       Result |= BaseOffsField;
   2471     if (ScaledReg != other.ScaledReg)
   2472       Result |= ScaledRegField;
   2473     // Don't count 0 as being a different scale, because that actually means
   2474     // unscaled (which will already be counted by having no ScaledReg).
   2475     if (Scale && other.Scale && Scale != other.Scale)
   2476       Result |= ScaleField;
   2477 
   2478     if (countPopulation(Result) > 1)
   2479       return MultipleFields;
   2480     else
   2481       return static_cast<FieldName>(Result);
   2482   }
   2483 
   2484   // An AddrMode is trivial if it involves no calculation i.e. it is just a base
   2485   // with no offset.
   2486   bool isTrivial() {
   2487     // An AddrMode is (BaseGV + BaseReg + BaseOffs + ScaleReg * Scale) so it is
   2488     // trivial if at most one of these terms is nonzero, except that BaseGV and
   2489     // BaseReg both being zero actually means a null pointer value, which we
   2490     // consider to be 'non-zero' here.
   2491     return !BaseOffs && !Scale && !(BaseGV && BaseReg);
   2492   }
   2493 
   2494   Value *GetFieldAsValue(FieldName Field, Type *IntPtrTy) {
   2495     switch (Field) {
   2496     default:
   2497       return nullptr;
   2498     case BaseRegField:
   2499       return BaseReg;
   2500     case BaseGVField:
   2501       return BaseGV;
   2502     case ScaledRegField:
   2503       return ScaledReg;
   2504     case BaseOffsField:
   2505       return ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, BaseOffs);
   2506     }
   2507   }
   2508 
   2509   void SetCombinedField(FieldName Field, Value *V,
   2510                         const SmallVectorImpl<ExtAddrMode> &AddrModes) {
   2511     switch (Field) {
   2512     default:
   2513       llvm_unreachable("Unhandled fields are expected to be rejected earlier");
   2514       break;
   2515     case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
   2516       BaseReg = V;
   2517       break;
   2518     case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
   2519       // A combined BaseGV is an Instruction, not a GlobalValue, so it goes
   2520       // in the BaseReg field.
   2521       assert(BaseReg == nullptr);
   2522       BaseReg = V;
   2523       BaseGV = nullptr;
   2524       break;
   2525     case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
   2526       ScaledReg = V;
   2527       // If we have a mix of scaled and unscaled addrmodes then we want scale
   2528       // to be the scale and not zero.
   2529       if (!Scale)
   2530         for (const ExtAddrMode &AM : AddrModes)
   2531           if (AM.Scale) {
   2532             Scale = AM.Scale;
   2533             break;
   2534           }
   2535       break;
   2536     case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
   2537       // The offset is no longer a constant, so it goes in ScaledReg with a
   2538       // scale of 1.
   2539       assert(ScaledReg == nullptr);
   2540       ScaledReg = V;
   2541       Scale = 1;
   2542       BaseOffs = 0;
   2543       break;
   2544     }
   2545   }
   2546 };
   2547 
   2548 } // end anonymous namespace
   2549 
   2550 #ifndef NDEBUG
   2551 static inline raw_ostream &operator<<(raw_ostream &OS, const ExtAddrMode &AM) {
   2552   AM.print(OS);
   2553   return OS;
   2554 }
   2555 #endif
   2556 
   2557 #if !defined(NDEBUG) || defined(LLVM_ENABLE_DUMP)
   2558 void ExtAddrMode::print(raw_ostream &OS) const {
   2559   bool NeedPlus = false;
   2560   OS << "[";
   2561   if (InBounds)
   2562     OS << "inbounds ";
   2563   if (BaseGV) {
   2564     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "")
   2565        << "GV:";
   2566     BaseGV->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
   2567     NeedPlus = true;
   2568   }
   2569 
   2570   if (BaseOffs) {
   2571     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "")
   2572        << BaseOffs;
   2573     NeedPlus = true;
   2574   }
   2575 
   2576   if (BaseReg) {
   2577     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "")
   2578        << "Base:";
   2579     BaseReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
   2580     NeedPlus = true;
   2581   }
   2582   if (Scale) {
   2583     OS << (NeedPlus ? " + " : "")
   2584        << Scale << "*";
   2585     ScaledReg->printAsOperand(OS, /*PrintType=*/false);
   2586   }
   2587 
   2588   OS << ']';
   2589 }
   2590 
   2591 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ExtAddrMode::dump() const {
   2592   print(dbgs());
   2593   dbgs() << '\n';
   2594 }
   2595 #endif
   2596 
   2597 namespace {
   2598 
   2599 /// This class provides transaction based operation on the IR.
   2600 /// Every change made through this class is recorded in the internal state and
   2601 /// can be undone (rollback) until commit is called.
   2602 /// CGP does not check if instructions could be speculatively executed when
   2603 /// moved. Preserving the original location would pessimize the debugging
   2604 /// experience, as well as negatively impact the quality of sample PGO.
   2605 class TypePromotionTransaction {
   2606   /// This represents the common interface of the individual transaction.
   2607   /// Each class implements the logic for doing one specific modification on
   2608   /// the IR via the TypePromotionTransaction.
   2609   class TypePromotionAction {
   2610   protected:
   2611     /// The Instruction modified.
   2612     Instruction *Inst;
   2613 
   2614   public:
   2615     /// Constructor of the action.
   2616     /// The constructor performs the related action on the IR.
   2617     TypePromotionAction(Instruction *Inst) : Inst(Inst) {}
   2618 
   2619     virtual ~TypePromotionAction() = default;
   2620 
   2621     /// Undo the modification done by this action.
   2622     /// When this method is called, the IR must be in the same state as it was
   2623     /// before this action was applied.
   2624     /// \pre Undoing the action works if and only if the IR is in the exact same
   2625     /// state as it was directly after this action was applied.
   2626     virtual void undo() = 0;
   2627 
   2628     /// Advocate every change made by this action.
   2629     /// When the results on the IR of the action are to be kept, it is important
   2630     /// to call this function, otherwise hidden information may be kept forever.
   2631     virtual void commit() {
   2632       // Nothing to be done, this action is not doing anything.
   2633     }
   2634   };
   2635 
   2636   /// Utility to remember the position of an instruction.
   2637   class InsertionHandler {
   2638     /// Position of an instruction.
   2639     /// Either an instruction:
   2640     /// - Is the first in a basic block: BB is used.
   2641     /// - Has a previous instruction: PrevInst is used.
   2642     union {
   2643       Instruction *PrevInst;
   2644       BasicBlock *BB;
   2645     } Point;
   2646 
   2647     /// Remember whether or not the instruction had a previous instruction.
   2648     bool HasPrevInstruction;
   2649 
   2650   public:
   2651     /// Record the position of \p Inst.
   2652     InsertionHandler(Instruction *Inst) {
   2653       BasicBlock::iterator It = Inst->getIterator();
   2654       HasPrevInstruction = (It != (Inst->getParent()->begin()));
   2655       if (HasPrevInstruction)
   2656         Point.PrevInst = &*--It;
   2657       else
   2658         Point.BB = Inst->getParent();
   2659     }
   2660 
   2661     /// Insert \p Inst at the recorded position.
   2662     void insert(Instruction *Inst) {
   2663       if (HasPrevInstruction) {
   2664         if (Inst->getParent())
   2665           Inst->removeFromParent();
   2666         Inst->insertAfter(Point.PrevInst);
   2667       } else {
   2668         Instruction *Position = &*Point.BB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   2669         if (Inst->getParent())
   2670           Inst->moveBefore(Position);
   2671         else
   2672           Inst->insertBefore(Position);
   2673       }
   2674     }
   2675   };
   2676 
   2677   /// Move an instruction before another.
   2678   class InstructionMoveBefore : public TypePromotionAction {
   2679     /// Original position of the instruction.
   2680     InsertionHandler Position;
   2681 
   2682   public:
   2683     /// Move \p Inst before \p Before.
   2684     InstructionMoveBefore(Instruction *Inst, Instruction *Before)
   2685         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Position(Inst) {
   2686       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: move: " << *Inst << "\nbefore: " << *Before
   2687                         << "\n");
   2688       Inst->moveBefore(Before);
   2689     }
   2690 
   2691     /// Move the instruction back to its original position.
   2692     void undo() override {
   2693       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: moveBefore: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2694       Position.insert(Inst);
   2695     }
   2696   };
   2697 
   2698   /// Set the operand of an instruction with a new value.
   2699   class OperandSetter : public TypePromotionAction {
   2700     /// Original operand of the instruction.
   2701     Value *Origin;
   2702 
   2703     /// Index of the modified instruction.
   2704     unsigned Idx;
   2705 
   2706   public:
   2707     /// Set \p Idx operand of \p Inst with \p NewVal.
   2708     OperandSetter(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal)
   2709         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Idx(Idx) {
   2710       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: setOperand: " << Idx << "\n"
   2711                         << "for:" << *Inst << "\n"
   2712                         << "with:" << *NewVal << "\n");
   2713       Origin = Inst->getOperand(Idx);
   2714       Inst->setOperand(Idx, NewVal);
   2715     }
   2716 
   2717     /// Restore the original value of the instruction.
   2718     void undo() override {
   2719       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: setOperand:" << Idx << "\n"
   2720                         << "for: " << *Inst << "\n"
   2721                         << "with: " << *Origin << "\n");
   2722       Inst->setOperand(Idx, Origin);
   2723     }
   2724   };
   2725 
   2726   /// Hide the operands of an instruction.
   2727   /// Do as if this instruction was not using any of its operands.
   2728   class OperandsHider : public TypePromotionAction {
   2729     /// The list of original operands.
   2730     SmallVector<Value *, 4> OriginalValues;
   2731 
   2732   public:
   2733     /// Remove \p Inst from the uses of the operands of \p Inst.
   2734     OperandsHider(Instruction *Inst) : TypePromotionAction(Inst) {
   2735       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2736       unsigned NumOpnds = Inst->getNumOperands();
   2737       OriginalValues.reserve(NumOpnds);
   2738       for (unsigned It = 0; It < NumOpnds; ++It) {
   2739         // Save the current operand.
   2740         Value *Val = Inst->getOperand(It);
   2741         OriginalValues.push_back(Val);
   2742         // Set a dummy one.
   2743         // We could use OperandSetter here, but that would imply an overhead
   2744         // that we are not willing to pay.
   2745         Inst->setOperand(It, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
   2746       }
   2747     }
   2748 
   2749     /// Restore the original list of uses.
   2750     void undo() override {
   2751       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: OperandsHider: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2752       for (unsigned It = 0, EndIt = OriginalValues.size(); It != EndIt; ++It)
   2753         Inst->setOperand(It, OriginalValues[It]);
   2754     }
   2755   };
   2756 
   2757   /// Build a truncate instruction.
   2758   class TruncBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
   2759     Value *Val;
   2760 
   2761   public:
   2762     /// Build a truncate instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
   2763     /// result.
   2764     /// trunc Opnd to Ty.
   2765     TruncBuilder(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty) : TypePromotionAction(Opnd) {
   2766       IRBuilder<> Builder(Opnd);
   2767       Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
   2768       Val = Builder.CreateTrunc(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
   2769       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2770     }
   2771 
   2772     /// Get the built value.
   2773     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
   2774 
   2775     /// Remove the built instruction.
   2776     void undo() override {
   2777       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: TruncBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2778       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
   2779         IVal->eraseFromParent();
   2780     }
   2781   };
   2782 
   2783   /// Build a sign extension instruction.
   2784   class SExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
   2785     Value *Val;
   2786 
   2787   public:
   2788     /// Build a sign extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
   2789     /// result.
   2790     /// sext Opnd to Ty.
   2791     SExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
   2792         : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
   2793       IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
   2794       Val = Builder.CreateSExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
   2795       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2796     }
   2797 
   2798     /// Get the built value.
   2799     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
   2800 
   2801     /// Remove the built instruction.
   2802     void undo() override {
   2803       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: SExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2804       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
   2805         IVal->eraseFromParent();
   2806     }
   2807   };
   2808 
   2809   /// Build a zero extension instruction.
   2810   class ZExtBuilder : public TypePromotionAction {
   2811     Value *Val;
   2812 
   2813   public:
   2814     /// Build a zero extension instruction of \p Opnd producing a \p Ty
   2815     /// result.
   2816     /// zext Opnd to Ty.
   2817     ZExtBuilder(Instruction *InsertPt, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty)
   2818         : TypePromotionAction(InsertPt) {
   2819       IRBuilder<> Builder(InsertPt);
   2820       Builder.SetCurrentDebugLocation(DebugLoc());
   2821       Val = Builder.CreateZExt(Opnd, Ty, "promoted");
   2822       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2823     }
   2824 
   2825     /// Get the built value.
   2826     Value *getBuiltValue() { return Val; }
   2827 
   2828     /// Remove the built instruction.
   2829     void undo() override {
   2830       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: ZExtBuilder: " << *Val << "\n");
   2831       if (Instruction *IVal = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
   2832         IVal->eraseFromParent();
   2833     }
   2834   };
   2835 
   2836   /// Mutate an instruction to another type.
   2837   class TypeMutator : public TypePromotionAction {
   2838     /// Record the original type.
   2839     Type *OrigTy;
   2840 
   2841   public:
   2842     /// Mutate the type of \p Inst into \p NewTy.
   2843     TypeMutator(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy)
   2844         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), OrigTy(Inst->getType()) {
   2845       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *NewTy
   2846                         << "\n");
   2847       Inst->mutateType(NewTy);
   2848     }
   2849 
   2850     /// Mutate the instruction back to its original type.
   2851     void undo() override {
   2852       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: MutateType: " << *Inst << " with " << *OrigTy
   2853                         << "\n");
   2854       Inst->mutateType(OrigTy);
   2855     }
   2856   };
   2857 
   2858   /// Replace the uses of an instruction by another instruction.
   2859   class UsesReplacer : public TypePromotionAction {
   2860     /// Helper structure to keep track of the replaced uses.
   2861     struct InstructionAndIdx {
   2862       /// The instruction using the instruction.
   2863       Instruction *Inst;
   2864 
   2865       /// The index where this instruction is used for Inst.
   2866       unsigned Idx;
   2867 
   2868       InstructionAndIdx(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx)
   2869           : Inst(Inst), Idx(Idx) {}
   2870     };
   2871 
   2872     /// Keep track of the original uses (pair Instruction, Index).
   2873     SmallVector<InstructionAndIdx, 4> OriginalUses;
   2874     /// Keep track of the debug users.
   2875     SmallVector<DbgValueInst *, 1> DbgValues;
   2876 
   2877     /// Keep track of the new value so that we can undo it by replacing
   2878     /// instances of the new value with the original value.
   2879     Value *New;
   2880 
   2881     using use_iterator = SmallVectorImpl<InstructionAndIdx>::iterator;
   2882 
   2883   public:
   2884     /// Replace all the use of \p Inst by \p New.
   2885     UsesReplacer(Instruction *Inst, Value *New)
   2886         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), New(New) {
   2887       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << " with " << *New
   2888                         << "\n");
   2889       // Record the original uses.
   2890       for (Use &U : Inst->uses()) {
   2891         Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
   2892         OriginalUses.push_back(InstructionAndIdx(UserI, U.getOperandNo()));
   2893       }
   2894       // Record the debug uses separately. They are not in the instruction's
   2895       // use list, but they are replaced by RAUW.
   2896       findDbgValues(DbgValues, Inst);
   2897 
   2898       // Now, we can replace the uses.
   2899       Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
   2900     }
   2901 
   2902     /// Reassign the original uses of Inst to Inst.
   2903     void undo() override {
   2904       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: UsersReplacer: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2905       for (InstructionAndIdx &Use : OriginalUses)
   2906         Use.Inst->setOperand(Use.Idx, Inst);
   2907       // RAUW has replaced all original uses with references to the new value,
   2908       // including the debug uses. Since we are undoing the replacements,
   2909       // the original debug uses must also be reinstated to maintain the
   2910       // correctness and utility of debug value instructions.
   2911       for (auto *DVI : DbgValues)
   2912         DVI->replaceVariableLocationOp(New, Inst);
   2913     }
   2914   };
   2915 
   2916   /// Remove an instruction from the IR.
   2917   class InstructionRemover : public TypePromotionAction {
   2918     /// Original position of the instruction.
   2919     InsertionHandler Inserter;
   2920 
   2921     /// Helper structure to hide all the link to the instruction. In other
   2922     /// words, this helps to do as if the instruction was removed.
   2923     OperandsHider Hider;
   2924 
   2925     /// Keep track of the uses replaced, if any.
   2926     UsesReplacer *Replacer = nullptr;
   2927 
   2928     /// Keep track of instructions removed.
   2929     SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
   2930 
   2931   public:
   2932     /// Remove all reference of \p Inst and optionally replace all its
   2933     /// uses with New.
   2934     /// \p RemovedInsts Keep track of the instructions removed by this Action.
   2935     /// \pre If !Inst->use_empty(), then New != nullptr
   2936     InstructionRemover(Instruction *Inst, SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts,
   2937                        Value *New = nullptr)
   2938         : TypePromotionAction(Inst), Inserter(Inst), Hider(Inst),
   2939           RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {
   2940       if (New)
   2941         Replacer = new UsesReplacer(Inst, New);
   2942       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Do: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2943       RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
   2944       /// The instructions removed here will be freed after completing
   2945       /// optimizeBlock() for all blocks as we need to keep track of the
   2946       /// removed instructions during promotion.
   2947       Inst->removeFromParent();
   2948     }
   2949 
   2950     ~InstructionRemover() override { delete Replacer; }
   2951 
   2952     /// Resurrect the instruction and reassign it to the proper uses if
   2953     /// new value was provided when build this action.
   2954     void undo() override {
   2955       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Undo: InstructionRemover: " << *Inst << "\n");
   2956       Inserter.insert(Inst);
   2957       if (Replacer)
   2958         Replacer->undo();
   2959       Hider.undo();
   2960       RemovedInsts.erase(Inst);
   2961     }
   2962   };
   2963 
   2964 public:
   2965   /// Restoration point.
   2966   /// The restoration point is a pointer to an action instead of an iterator
   2967   /// because the iterator may be invalidated but not the pointer.
   2968   using ConstRestorationPt = const TypePromotionAction *;
   2969 
   2970   TypePromotionTransaction(SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts)
   2971       : RemovedInsts(RemovedInsts) {}
   2972 
   2973   /// Advocate every changes made in that transaction. Return true if any change
   2974   /// happen.
   2975   bool commit();
   2976 
   2977   /// Undo all the changes made after the given point.
   2978   void rollback(ConstRestorationPt Point);
   2979 
   2980   /// Get the current restoration point.
   2981   ConstRestorationPt getRestorationPoint() const;
   2982 
   2983   /// \name API for IR modification with state keeping to support rollback.
   2984   /// @{
   2985   /// Same as Instruction::setOperand.
   2986   void setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx, Value *NewVal);
   2987 
   2988   /// Same as Instruction::eraseFromParent.
   2989   void eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst, Value *NewVal = nullptr);
   2990 
   2991   /// Same as Value::replaceAllUsesWith.
   2992   void replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst, Value *New);
   2993 
   2994   /// Same as Value::mutateType.
   2995   void mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy);
   2996 
   2997   /// Same as IRBuilder::createTrunc.
   2998   Value *createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd, Type *Ty);
   2999 
   3000   /// Same as IRBuilder::createSExt.
   3001   Value *createSExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
   3002 
   3003   /// Same as IRBuilder::createZExt.
   3004   Value *createZExt(Instruction *Inst, Value *Opnd, Type *Ty);
   3005 
   3006   /// Same as Instruction::moveBefore.
   3007   void moveBefore(Instruction *Inst, Instruction *Before);
   3008   /// @}
   3009 
   3010 private:
   3011   /// The ordered list of actions made so far.
   3012   SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>, 16> Actions;
   3013 
   3014   using CommitPt = SmallVectorImpl<std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction>>::iterator;
   3015 
   3016   SetOfInstrs &RemovedInsts;
   3017 };
   3018 
   3019 } // end anonymous namespace
   3020 
   3021 void TypePromotionTransaction::setOperand(Instruction *Inst, unsigned Idx,
   3022                                           Value *NewVal) {
   3023   Actions.push_back(std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::OperandSetter>(
   3024       Inst, Idx, NewVal));
   3025 }
   3026 
   3027 void TypePromotionTransaction::eraseInstruction(Instruction *Inst,
   3028                                                 Value *NewVal) {
   3029   Actions.push_back(
   3030       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::InstructionRemover>(
   3031           Inst, RemovedInsts, NewVal));
   3032 }
   3033 
   3034 void TypePromotionTransaction::replaceAllUsesWith(Instruction *Inst,
   3035                                                   Value *New) {
   3036   Actions.push_back(
   3037       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::UsesReplacer>(Inst, New));
   3038 }
   3039 
   3040 void TypePromotionTransaction::mutateType(Instruction *Inst, Type *NewTy) {
   3041   Actions.push_back(
   3042       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::TypeMutator>(Inst, NewTy));
   3043 }
   3044 
   3045 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createTrunc(Instruction *Opnd,
   3046                                              Type *Ty) {
   3047   std::unique_ptr<TruncBuilder> Ptr(new TruncBuilder(Opnd, Ty));
   3048   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
   3049   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
   3050   return Val;
   3051 }
   3052 
   3053 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createSExt(Instruction *Inst,
   3054                                             Value *Opnd, Type *Ty) {
   3055   std::unique_ptr<SExtBuilder> Ptr(new SExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
   3056   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
   3057   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
   3058   return Val;
   3059 }
   3060 
   3061 Value *TypePromotionTransaction::createZExt(Instruction *Inst,
   3062                                             Value *Opnd, Type *Ty) {
   3063   std::unique_ptr<ZExtBuilder> Ptr(new ZExtBuilder(Inst, Opnd, Ty));
   3064   Value *Val = Ptr->getBuiltValue();
   3065   Actions.push_back(std::move(Ptr));
   3066   return Val;
   3067 }
   3068 
   3069 void TypePromotionTransaction::moveBefore(Instruction *Inst,
   3070                                           Instruction *Before) {
   3071   Actions.push_back(
   3072       std::make_unique<TypePromotionTransaction::InstructionMoveBefore>(
   3073           Inst, Before));
   3074 }
   3075 
   3076 TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt
   3077 TypePromotionTransaction::getRestorationPoint() const {
   3078   return !Actions.empty() ? Actions.back().get() : nullptr;
   3079 }
   3080 
   3081 bool TypePromotionTransaction::commit() {
   3082   for (std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> &Action : Actions)
   3083     Action->commit();
   3084   bool Modified = !Actions.empty();
   3085   Actions.clear();
   3086   return Modified;
   3087 }
   3088 
   3089 void TypePromotionTransaction::rollback(
   3090     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt Point) {
   3091   while (!Actions.empty() && Point != Actions.back().get()) {
   3092     std::unique_ptr<TypePromotionAction> Curr = Actions.pop_back_val();
   3093     Curr->undo();
   3094   }
   3095 }
   3096 
   3097 namespace {
   3098 
   3099 /// A helper class for matching addressing modes.
   3100 ///
   3101 /// This encapsulates the logic for matching the target-legal addressing modes.
   3102 class AddressingModeMatcher {
   3103   SmallVectorImpl<Instruction*> &AddrModeInsts;
   3104   const TargetLowering &TLI;
   3105   const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI;
   3106   const DataLayout &DL;
   3107   const LoopInfo &LI;
   3108   const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn;
   3109 
   3110   /// AccessTy/MemoryInst - This is the type for the access (e.g. double) and
   3111   /// the memory instruction that we're computing this address for.
   3112   Type *AccessTy;
   3113   unsigned AddrSpace;
   3114   Instruction *MemoryInst;
   3115 
   3116   /// This is the addressing mode that we're building up. This is
   3117   /// part of the return value of this addressing mode matching stuff.
   3118   ExtAddrMode &AddrMode;
   3119 
   3120   /// The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare optimizations.
   3121   const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts;
   3122 
   3123   /// A map from the instructions to their type before promotion.
   3124   InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts;
   3125 
   3126   /// The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
   3127   TypePromotionTransaction &TPT;
   3128 
   3129   // A GEP which has too large offset to be folded into the addressing mode.
   3130   std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP;
   3131 
   3132   /// This is set to true when we should not do profitability checks.
   3133   /// When true, IsProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode always returns true.
   3134   bool IgnoreProfitability;
   3135 
   3136   /// True if we are optimizing for size.
   3137   bool OptSize;
   3138 
   3139   ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI;
   3140   BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI;
   3141 
   3142   AddressingModeMatcher(
   3143       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AMI, const TargetLowering &TLI,
   3144       const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const LoopInfo &LI,
   3145       const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn,
   3146       Type *AT, unsigned AS, Instruction *MI, ExtAddrMode &AM,
   3147       const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts, InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   3148       TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   3149       std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
   3150       bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI)
   3151       : AddrModeInsts(AMI), TLI(TLI), TRI(TRI),
   3152         DL(MI->getModule()->getDataLayout()), LI(LI), getDTFn(getDTFn),
   3153         AccessTy(AT), AddrSpace(AS), MemoryInst(MI), AddrMode(AM),
   3154         InsertedInsts(InsertedInsts), PromotedInsts(PromotedInsts), TPT(TPT),
   3155         LargeOffsetGEP(LargeOffsetGEP), OptSize(OptSize), PSI(PSI), BFI(BFI) {
   3156     IgnoreProfitability = false;
   3157   }
   3158 
   3159 public:
   3160   /// Find the maximal addressing mode that a load/store of V can fold,
   3161   /// give an access type of AccessTy.  This returns a list of involved
   3162   /// instructions in AddrModeInsts.
   3163   /// \p InsertedInsts The instructions inserted by other CodeGenPrepare
   3164   /// optimizations.
   3165   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
   3166   /// \p The ongoing transaction where every action should be registered.
   3167   static ExtAddrMode
   3168   Match(Value *V, Type *AccessTy, unsigned AS, Instruction *MemoryInst,
   3169         SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &AddrModeInsts,
   3170         const TargetLowering &TLI, const LoopInfo &LI,
   3171         const std::function<const DominatorTree &()> getDTFn,
   3172         const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
   3173         InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   3174         std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> &LargeOffsetGEP,
   3175         bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI, BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI) {
   3176     ExtAddrMode Result;
   3177 
   3178     bool Success = AddressingModeMatcher(
   3179         AddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn, AccessTy, AS, MemoryInst, Result,
   3180         InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT, LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI,
   3181         BFI).matchAddr(V, 0);
   3182     (void)Success; assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
   3183     return Result;
   3184   }
   3185 
   3186 private:
   3187   bool matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale, unsigned Depth);
   3188   bool matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth);
   3189   bool matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode, unsigned Depth,
   3190                           bool *MovedAway = nullptr);
   3191   bool isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction *I,
   3192                                             ExtAddrMode &AMBefore,
   3193                                             ExtAddrMode &AMAfter);
   3194   bool valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val, Value *KnownLive1, Value *KnownLive2);
   3195   bool isPromotionProfitable(unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost,
   3196                              Value *PromotedOperand) const;
   3197 };
   3198 
   3199 class PhiNodeSet;
   3200 
   3201 /// An iterator for PhiNodeSet.
   3202 class PhiNodeSetIterator {
   3203   PhiNodeSet * const Set;
   3204   size_t CurrentIndex = 0;
   3205 
   3206 public:
   3207   /// The constructor. Start should point to either a valid element, or be equal
   3208   /// to the size of the underlying SmallVector of the PhiNodeSet.
   3209   PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet * const Set, size_t Start);
   3210   PHINode * operator*() const;
   3211   PhiNodeSetIterator& operator++();
   3212   bool operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
   3213   bool operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const;
   3214 };
   3215 
   3216 /// Keeps a set of PHINodes.
   3217 ///
   3218 /// This is a minimal set implementation for a specific use case:
   3219 /// It is very fast when there are very few elements, but also provides good
   3220 /// performance when there are many. It is similar to SmallPtrSet, but also
   3221 /// provides iteration by insertion order, which is deterministic and stable
   3222 /// across runs. It is also similar to SmallSetVector, but provides removing
   3223 /// elements in O(1) time. This is achieved by not actually removing the element
   3224 /// from the underlying vector, so comes at the cost of using more memory, but
   3225 /// that is fine, since PhiNodeSets are used as short lived objects.
   3226 class PhiNodeSet {
   3227   friend class PhiNodeSetIterator;
   3228 
   3229   using MapType = SmallDenseMap<PHINode *, size_t, 32>;
   3230   using iterator =  PhiNodeSetIterator;
   3231 
   3232   /// Keeps the elements in the order of their insertion in the underlying
   3233   /// vector. To achieve constant time removal, it never deletes any element.
   3234   SmallVector<PHINode *, 32> NodeList;
   3235 
   3236   /// Keeps the elements in the underlying set implementation. This (and not the
   3237   /// NodeList defined above) is the source of truth on whether an element
   3238   /// is actually in the collection.
   3239   MapType NodeMap;
   3240 
   3241   /// Points to the first valid (not deleted) element when the set is not empty
   3242   /// and the value is not zero. Equals to the size of the underlying vector
   3243   /// when the set is empty. When the value is 0, as in the beginning, the
   3244   /// first element may or may not be valid.
   3245   size_t FirstValidElement = 0;
   3246 
   3247 public:
   3248   /// Inserts a new element to the collection.
   3249   /// \returns true if the element is actually added, i.e. was not in the
   3250   /// collection before the operation.
   3251   bool insert(PHINode *Ptr) {
   3252     if (NodeMap.insert(std::make_pair(Ptr, NodeList.size())).second) {
   3253       NodeList.push_back(Ptr);
   3254       return true;
   3255     }
   3256     return false;
   3257   }
   3258 
   3259   /// Removes the element from the collection.
   3260   /// \returns whether the element is actually removed, i.e. was in the
   3261   /// collection before the operation.
   3262   bool erase(PHINode *Ptr) {
   3263     if (NodeMap.erase(Ptr)) {
   3264       SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
   3265       return true;
   3266     }
   3267     return false;
   3268   }
   3269 
   3270   /// Removes all elements and clears the collection.
   3271   void clear() {
   3272     NodeMap.clear();
   3273     NodeList.clear();
   3274     FirstValidElement = 0;
   3275   }
   3276 
   3277   /// \returns an iterator that will iterate the elements in the order of
   3278   /// insertion.
   3279   iterator begin() {
   3280     if (FirstValidElement == 0)
   3281       SkipRemovedElements(FirstValidElement);
   3282     return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, FirstValidElement);
   3283   }
   3284 
   3285   /// \returns an iterator that points to the end of the collection.
   3286   iterator end() { return PhiNodeSetIterator(this, NodeList.size()); }
   3287 
   3288   /// Returns the number of elements in the collection.
   3289   size_t size() const {
   3290     return NodeMap.size();
   3291   }
   3292 
   3293   /// \returns 1 if the given element is in the collection, and 0 if otherwise.
   3294   size_t count(PHINode *Ptr) const {
   3295     return NodeMap.count(Ptr);
   3296   }
   3297 
   3298 private:
   3299   /// Updates the CurrentIndex so that it will point to a valid element.
   3300   ///
   3301   /// If the element of NodeList at CurrentIndex is valid, it does not
   3302   /// change it. If there are no more valid elements, it updates CurrentIndex
   3303   /// to point to the end of the NodeList.
   3304   void SkipRemovedElements(size_t &CurrentIndex) {
   3305     while (CurrentIndex < NodeList.size()) {
   3306       auto it = NodeMap.find(NodeList[CurrentIndex]);
   3307       // If the element has been deleted and added again later, NodeMap will
   3308       // point to a different index, so CurrentIndex will still be invalid.
   3309       if (it != NodeMap.end() && it->second == CurrentIndex)
   3310         break;
   3311       ++CurrentIndex;
   3312     }
   3313   }
   3314 };
   3315 
   3316 PhiNodeSetIterator::PhiNodeSetIterator(PhiNodeSet *const Set, size_t Start)
   3317     : Set(Set), CurrentIndex(Start) {}
   3318 
   3319 PHINode * PhiNodeSetIterator::operator*() const {
   3320   assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
   3321          "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
   3322   return Set->NodeList[CurrentIndex];
   3323 }
   3324 
   3325 PhiNodeSetIterator& PhiNodeSetIterator::operator++() {
   3326   assert(CurrentIndex < Set->NodeList.size() &&
   3327          "PhiNodeSet access out of range");
   3328   ++CurrentIndex;
   3329   Set->SkipRemovedElements(CurrentIndex);
   3330   return *this;
   3331 }
   3332 
   3333 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator==(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
   3334   return CurrentIndex == RHS.CurrentIndex;
   3335 }
   3336 
   3337 bool PhiNodeSetIterator::operator!=(const PhiNodeSetIterator &RHS) const {
   3338   return !((*this) == RHS);
   3339 }
   3340 
   3341 /// Keep track of simplification of Phi nodes.
   3342 /// Accept the set of all phi nodes and erase phi node from this set
   3343 /// if it is simplified.
   3344 class SimplificationTracker {
   3345   DenseMap<Value *, Value *> Storage;
   3346   const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
   3347   // Tracks newly created Phi nodes. The elements are iterated by insertion
   3348   // order.
   3349   PhiNodeSet AllPhiNodes;
   3350   // Tracks newly created Select nodes.
   3351   SmallPtrSet<SelectInst *, 32> AllSelectNodes;
   3352 
   3353 public:
   3354   SimplificationTracker(const SimplifyQuery &sq)
   3355       : SQ(sq) {}
   3356 
   3357   Value *Get(Value *V) {
   3358     do {
   3359       auto SV = Storage.find(V);
   3360       if (SV == Storage.end())
   3361         return V;
   3362       V = SV->second;
   3363     } while (true);
   3364   }
   3365 
   3366   Value *Simplify(Value *Val) {
   3367     SmallVector<Value *, 32> WorkList;
   3368     SmallPtrSet<Value *, 32> Visited;
   3369     WorkList.push_back(Val);
   3370     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
   3371       auto *P = WorkList.pop_back_val();
   3372       if (!Visited.insert(P).second)
   3373         continue;
   3374       if (auto *PI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(P))
   3375         if (Value *V = SimplifyInstruction(cast<Instruction>(PI), SQ)) {
   3376           for (auto *U : PI->users())
   3377             WorkList.push_back(cast<Value>(U));
   3378           Put(PI, V);
   3379           PI->replaceAllUsesWith(V);
   3380           if (auto *PHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PI))
   3381             AllPhiNodes.erase(PHI);
   3382           if (auto *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(PI))
   3383             AllSelectNodes.erase(Select);
   3384           PI->eraseFromParent();
   3385         }
   3386     }
   3387     return Get(Val);
   3388   }
   3389 
   3390   void Put(Value *From, Value *To) {
   3391     Storage.insert({ From, To });
   3392   }
   3393 
   3394   void ReplacePhi(PHINode *From, PHINode *To) {
   3395     Value* OldReplacement = Get(From);
   3396     while (OldReplacement != From) {
   3397       From = To;
   3398       To = dyn_cast<PHINode>(OldReplacement);
   3399       OldReplacement = Get(From);
   3400     }
   3401     assert(To && Get(To) == To && "Replacement PHI node is already replaced.");
   3402     Put(From, To);
   3403     From->replaceAllUsesWith(To);
   3404     AllPhiNodes.erase(From);
   3405     From->eraseFromParent();
   3406   }
   3407 
   3408   PhiNodeSet& newPhiNodes() { return AllPhiNodes; }
   3409 
   3410   void insertNewPhi(PHINode *PN) { AllPhiNodes.insert(PN); }
   3411 
   3412   void insertNewSelect(SelectInst *SI) { AllSelectNodes.insert(SI); }
   3413 
   3414   unsigned countNewPhiNodes() const { return AllPhiNodes.size(); }
   3415 
   3416   unsigned countNewSelectNodes() const { return AllSelectNodes.size(); }
   3417 
   3418   void destroyNewNodes(Type *CommonType) {
   3419     // For safe erasing, replace the uses with dummy value first.
   3420     auto *Dummy = UndefValue::get(CommonType);
   3421     for (auto *I : AllPhiNodes) {
   3422       I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
   3423       I->eraseFromParent();
   3424     }
   3425     AllPhiNodes.clear();
   3426     for (auto *I : AllSelectNodes) {
   3427       I->replaceAllUsesWith(Dummy);
   3428       I->eraseFromParent();
   3429     }
   3430     AllSelectNodes.clear();
   3431   }
   3432 };
   3433 
   3434 /// A helper class for combining addressing modes.
   3435 class AddressingModeCombiner {
   3436   typedef DenseMap<Value *, Value *> FoldAddrToValueMapping;
   3437   typedef std::pair<PHINode *, PHINode *> PHIPair;
   3438 
   3439 private:
   3440   /// The addressing modes we've collected.
   3441   SmallVector<ExtAddrMode, 16> AddrModes;
   3442 
   3443   /// The field in which the AddrModes differ, when we have more than one.
   3444   ExtAddrMode::FieldName DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::NoField;
   3445 
   3446   /// Are the AddrModes that we have all just equal to their original values?
   3447   bool AllAddrModesTrivial = true;
   3448 
   3449   /// Common Type for all different fields in addressing modes.
   3450   Type *CommonType;
   3451 
   3452   /// SimplifyQuery for simplifyInstruction utility.
   3453   const SimplifyQuery &SQ;
   3454 
   3455   /// Original Address.
   3456   Value *Original;
   3457 
   3458 public:
   3459   AddressingModeCombiner(const SimplifyQuery &_SQ, Value *OriginalValue)
   3460       : CommonType(nullptr), SQ(_SQ), Original(OriginalValue) {}
   3461 
   3462   /// Get the combined AddrMode
   3463   const ExtAddrMode &getAddrMode() const {
   3464     return AddrModes[0];
   3465   }
   3466 
   3467   /// Add a new AddrMode if it's compatible with the AddrModes we already
   3468   /// have.
   3469   /// \return True iff we succeeded in doing so.
   3470   bool addNewAddrMode(ExtAddrMode &NewAddrMode) {
   3471     // Take note of if we have any non-trivial AddrModes, as we need to detect
   3472     // when all AddrModes are trivial as then we would introduce a phi or select
   3473     // which just duplicates what's already there.
   3474     AllAddrModesTrivial = AllAddrModesTrivial && NewAddrMode.isTrivial();
   3475 
   3476     // If this is the first addrmode then everything is fine.
   3477     if (AddrModes.empty()) {
   3478       AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
   3479       return true;
   3480     }
   3481 
   3482     // Figure out how different this is from the other address modes, which we
   3483     // can do just by comparing against the first one given that we only care
   3484     // about the cumulative difference.
   3485     ExtAddrMode::FieldName ThisDifferentField =
   3486       AddrModes[0].compare(NewAddrMode);
   3487     if (DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
   3488       DifferentField = ThisDifferentField;
   3489     else if (DifferentField != ThisDifferentField)
   3490       DifferentField = ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
   3491 
   3492     // If NewAddrMode differs in more than one dimension we cannot handle it.
   3493     bool CanHandle = DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::MultipleFields;
   3494 
   3495     // If Scale Field is different then we reject.
   3496     CanHandle = CanHandle && DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::ScaleField;
   3497 
   3498     // We also must reject the case when base offset is different and
   3499     // scale reg is not null, we cannot handle this case due to merge of
   3500     // different offsets will be used as ScaleReg.
   3501     CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField ||
   3502                               !NewAddrMode.ScaledReg);
   3503 
   3504     // We also must reject the case when GV is different and BaseReg installed
   3505     // due to we want to use base reg as a merge of GV values.
   3506     CanHandle = CanHandle && (DifferentField != ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField ||
   3507                               !NewAddrMode.HasBaseReg);
   3508 
   3509     // Even if NewAddMode is the same we still need to collect it due to
   3510     // original value is different. And later we will need all original values
   3511     // as anchors during finding the common Phi node.
   3512     if (CanHandle)
   3513       AddrModes.emplace_back(NewAddrMode);
   3514     else
   3515       AddrModes.clear();
   3516 
   3517     return CanHandle;
   3518   }
   3519 
   3520   /// Combine the addressing modes we've collected into a single
   3521   /// addressing mode.
   3522   /// \return True iff we successfully combined them or we only had one so
   3523   /// didn't need to combine them anyway.
   3524   bool combineAddrModes() {
   3525     // If we have no AddrModes then they can't be combined.
   3526     if (AddrModes.size() == 0)
   3527       return false;
   3528 
   3529     // A single AddrMode can trivially be combined.
   3530     if (AddrModes.size() == 1 || DifferentField == ExtAddrMode::NoField)
   3531       return true;
   3532 
   3533     // If the AddrModes we collected are all just equal to the value they are
   3534     // derived from then combining them wouldn't do anything useful.
   3535     if (AllAddrModesTrivial)
   3536       return false;
   3537 
   3538     if (!addrModeCombiningAllowed())
   3539       return false;
   3540 
   3541     // Build a map between <original value, basic block where we saw it> to
   3542     // value of base register.
   3543     // Bail out if there is no common type.
   3544     FoldAddrToValueMapping Map;
   3545     if (!initializeMap(Map))
   3546       return false;
   3547 
   3548     Value *CommonValue = findCommon(Map);
   3549     if (CommonValue)
   3550       AddrModes[0].SetCombinedField(DifferentField, CommonValue, AddrModes);
   3551     return CommonValue != nullptr;
   3552   }
   3553 
   3554 private:
   3555   /// Initialize Map with anchor values. For address seen
   3556   /// we set the value of different field saw in this address.
   3557   /// At the same time we find a common type for different field we will
   3558   /// use to create new Phi/Select nodes. Keep it in CommonType field.
   3559   /// Return false if there is no common type found.
   3560   bool initializeMap(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
   3561     // Keep track of keys where the value is null. We will need to replace it
   3562     // with constant null when we know the common type.
   3563     SmallVector<Value *, 2> NullValue;
   3564     Type *IntPtrTy = SQ.DL.getIntPtrType(AddrModes[0].OriginalValue->getType());
   3565     for (auto &AM : AddrModes) {
   3566       Value *DV = AM.GetFieldAsValue(DifferentField, IntPtrTy);
   3567       if (DV) {
   3568         auto *Type = DV->getType();
   3569         if (CommonType && CommonType != Type)
   3570           return false;
   3571         CommonType = Type;
   3572         Map[AM.OriginalValue] = DV;
   3573       } else {
   3574         NullValue.push_back(AM.OriginalValue);
   3575       }
   3576     }
   3577     assert(CommonType && "At least one non-null value must be!");
   3578     for (auto *V : NullValue)
   3579       Map[V] = Constant::getNullValue(CommonType);
   3580     return true;
   3581   }
   3582 
   3583   /// We have mapping between value A and other value B where B was a field in
   3584   /// addressing mode represented by A. Also we have an original value C
   3585   /// representing an address we start with. Traversing from C through phi and
   3586   /// selects we ended up with A's in a map. This utility function tries to find
   3587   /// a value V which is a field in addressing mode C and traversing through phi
   3588   /// nodes and selects we will end up in corresponded values B in a map.
   3589   /// The utility will create a new Phi/Selects if needed.
   3590   // The simple example looks as follows:
   3591   // BB1:
   3592   //   p1 = b1 + 40
   3593   //   br cond BB2, BB3
   3594   // BB2:
   3595   //   p2 = b2 + 40
   3596   //   br BB3
   3597   // BB3:
   3598   //   p = phi [p1, BB1], [p2, BB2]
   3599   //   v = load p
   3600   // Map is
   3601   //   p1 -> b1
   3602   //   p2 -> b2
   3603   // Request is
   3604   //   p -> ?
   3605   // The function tries to find or build phi [b1, BB1], [b2, BB2] in BB3.
   3606   Value *findCommon(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map) {
   3607     // Tracks the simplification of newly created phi nodes. The reason we use
   3608     // this mapping is because we will add new created Phi nodes in AddrToBase.
   3609     // Simplification of Phi nodes is recursive, so some Phi node may
   3610     // be simplified after we added it to AddrToBase. In reality this
   3611     // simplification is possible only if original phi/selects were not
   3612     // simplified yet.
   3613     // Using this mapping we can find the current value in AddrToBase.
   3614     SimplificationTracker ST(SQ);
   3615 
   3616     // First step, DFS to create PHI nodes for all intermediate blocks.
   3617     // Also fill traverse order for the second step.
   3618     SmallVector<Value *, 32> TraverseOrder;
   3619     InsertPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
   3620 
   3621     // Second Step, fill new nodes by merged values and simplify if possible.
   3622     FillPlaceholders(Map, TraverseOrder, ST);
   3623 
   3624     if (!AddrSinkNewSelects && ST.countNewSelectNodes() > 0) {
   3625       ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
   3626       return nullptr;
   3627     }
   3628 
   3629     // Now we'd like to match New Phi nodes to existed ones.
   3630     unsigned PhiNotMatchedCount = 0;
   3631     if (!MatchPhiSet(ST, AddrSinkNewPhis, PhiNotMatchedCount)) {
   3632       ST.destroyNewNodes(CommonType);
   3633       return nullptr;
   3634     }
   3635 
   3636     auto *Result = ST.Get(Map.find(Original)->second);
   3637     if (Result) {
   3638       NumMemoryInstsPhiCreated += ST.countNewPhiNodes() + PhiNotMatchedCount;
   3639       NumMemoryInstsSelectCreated += ST.countNewSelectNodes();
   3640     }
   3641     return Result;
   3642   }
   3643 
   3644   /// Try to match PHI node to Candidate.
   3645   /// Matcher tracks the matched Phi nodes.
   3646   bool MatchPhiNode(PHINode *PHI, PHINode *Candidate,
   3647                     SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> &Matcher,
   3648                     PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch) {
   3649     SmallVector<PHIPair, 8> WorkList;
   3650     Matcher.insert({ PHI, Candidate });
   3651     SmallSet<PHINode *, 8> MatchedPHIs;
   3652     MatchedPHIs.insert(PHI);
   3653     WorkList.push_back({ PHI, Candidate });
   3654     SmallSet<PHIPair, 8> Visited;
   3655     while (!WorkList.empty()) {
   3656       auto Item = WorkList.pop_back_val();
   3657       if (!Visited.insert(Item).second)
   3658         continue;
   3659       // We iterate over all incoming values to Phi to compare them.
   3660       // If values are different and both of them Phi and the first one is a
   3661       // Phi we added (subject to match) and both of them is in the same basic
   3662       // block then we can match our pair if values match. So we state that
   3663       // these values match and add it to work list to verify that.
   3664       for (auto B : Item.first->blocks()) {
   3665         Value *FirstValue = Item.first->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
   3666         Value *SecondValue = Item.second->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
   3667         if (FirstValue == SecondValue)
   3668           continue;
   3669 
   3670         PHINode *FirstPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(FirstValue);
   3671         PHINode *SecondPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(SecondValue);
   3672 
   3673         // One of them is not Phi or
   3674         // The first one is not Phi node from the set we'd like to match or
   3675         // Phi nodes from different basic blocks then
   3676         // we will not be able to match.
   3677         if (!FirstPhi || !SecondPhi || !PhiNodesToMatch.count(FirstPhi) ||
   3678             FirstPhi->getParent() != SecondPhi->getParent())
   3679           return false;
   3680 
   3681         // If we already matched them then continue.
   3682         if (Matcher.count({ FirstPhi, SecondPhi }))
   3683           continue;
   3684         // So the values are different and does not match. So we need them to
   3685         // match. (But we register no more than one match per PHI node, so that
   3686         // we won't later try to replace them twice.)
   3687         if (MatchedPHIs.insert(FirstPhi).second)
   3688           Matcher.insert({ FirstPhi, SecondPhi });
   3689         // But me must check it.
   3690         WorkList.push_back({ FirstPhi, SecondPhi });
   3691       }
   3692     }
   3693     return true;
   3694   }
   3695 
   3696   /// For the given set of PHI nodes (in the SimplificationTracker) try
   3697   /// to find their equivalents.
   3698   /// Returns false if this matching fails and creation of new Phi is disabled.
   3699   bool MatchPhiSet(SimplificationTracker &ST, bool AllowNewPhiNodes,
   3700                    unsigned &PhiNotMatchedCount) {
   3701     // Matched and PhiNodesToMatch iterate their elements in a deterministic
   3702     // order, so the replacements (ReplacePhi) are also done in a deterministic
   3703     // order.
   3704     SmallSetVector<PHIPair, 8> Matched;
   3705     SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 8> WillNotMatch;
   3706     PhiNodeSet &PhiNodesToMatch = ST.newPhiNodes();
   3707     while (PhiNodesToMatch.size()) {
   3708       PHINode *PHI = *PhiNodesToMatch.begin();
   3709 
   3710       // Add us, if no Phi nodes in the basic block we do not match.
   3711       WillNotMatch.clear();
   3712       WillNotMatch.insert(PHI);
   3713 
   3714       // Traverse all Phis until we found equivalent or fail to do that.
   3715       bool IsMatched = false;
   3716       for (auto &P : PHI->getParent()->phis()) {
   3717         if (&P == PHI)
   3718           continue;
   3719         if ((IsMatched = MatchPhiNode(PHI, &P, Matched, PhiNodesToMatch)))
   3720           break;
   3721         // If it does not match, collect all Phi nodes from matcher.
   3722         // if we end up with no match, them all these Phi nodes will not match
   3723         // later.
   3724         for (auto M : Matched)
   3725           WillNotMatch.insert(M.first);
   3726         Matched.clear();
   3727       }
   3728       if (IsMatched) {
   3729         // Replace all matched values and erase them.
   3730         for (auto MV : Matched)
   3731           ST.ReplacePhi(MV.first, MV.second);
   3732         Matched.clear();
   3733         continue;
   3734       }
   3735       // If we are not allowed to create new nodes then bail out.
   3736       if (!AllowNewPhiNodes)
   3737         return false;
   3738       // Just remove all seen values in matcher. They will not match anything.
   3739       PhiNotMatchedCount += WillNotMatch.size();
   3740       for (auto *P : WillNotMatch)
   3741         PhiNodesToMatch.erase(P);
   3742     }
   3743     return true;
   3744   }
   3745   /// Fill the placeholders with values from predecessors and simplify them.
   3746   void FillPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
   3747                         SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
   3748                         SimplificationTracker &ST) {
   3749     while (!TraverseOrder.empty()) {
   3750       Value *Current = TraverseOrder.pop_back_val();
   3751       assert(Map.find(Current) != Map.end() && "No node to fill!!!");
   3752       Value *V = Map[Current];
   3753 
   3754       if (SelectInst *Select = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
   3755         // CurrentValue also must be Select.
   3756         auto *CurrentSelect = cast<SelectInst>(Current);
   3757         auto *TrueValue = CurrentSelect->getTrueValue();
   3758         assert(Map.find(TrueValue) != Map.end() && "No True Value!");
   3759         Select->setTrueValue(ST.Get(Map[TrueValue]));
   3760         auto *FalseValue = CurrentSelect->getFalseValue();
   3761         assert(Map.find(FalseValue) != Map.end() && "No False Value!");
   3762         Select->setFalseValue(ST.Get(Map[FalseValue]));
   3763       } else {
   3764         // Must be a Phi node then.
   3765         auto *PHI = cast<PHINode>(V);
   3766         // Fill the Phi node with values from predecessors.
   3767         for (auto *B : predecessors(PHI->getParent())) {
   3768           Value *PV = cast<PHINode>(Current)->getIncomingValueForBlock(B);
   3769           assert(Map.find(PV) != Map.end() && "No predecessor Value!");
   3770           PHI->addIncoming(ST.Get(Map[PV]), B);
   3771         }
   3772       }
   3773       Map[Current] = ST.Simplify(V);
   3774     }
   3775   }
   3776 
   3777   /// Starting from original value recursively iterates over def-use chain up to
   3778   /// known ending values represented in a map. For each traversed phi/select
   3779   /// inserts a placeholder Phi or Select.
   3780   /// Reports all new created Phi/Select nodes by adding them to set.
   3781   /// Also reports and order in what values have been traversed.
   3782   void InsertPlaceholders(FoldAddrToValueMapping &Map,
   3783                           SmallVectorImpl<Value *> &TraverseOrder,
   3784                           SimplificationTracker &ST) {
   3785     SmallVector<Value *, 32> Worklist;
   3786     assert((isa<PHINode>(Original) || isa<SelectInst>(Original)) &&
   3787            "Address must be a Phi or Select node");
   3788     auto *Dummy = UndefValue::get(CommonType);
   3789     Worklist.push_back(Original);
   3790     while (!Worklist.empty()) {
   3791       Value *Current = Worklist.pop_back_val();
   3792       // if it is already visited or it is an ending value then skip it.
   3793       if (Map.find(Current) != Map.end())
   3794         continue;
   3795       TraverseOrder.push_back(Current);
   3796 
   3797       // CurrentValue must be a Phi node or select. All others must be covered
   3798       // by anchors.
   3799       if (SelectInst *CurrentSelect = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Current)) {
   3800         // Is it OK to get metadata from OrigSelect?!
   3801         // Create a Select placeholder with dummy value.
   3802         SelectInst *Select = SelectInst::Create(
   3803             CurrentSelect->getCondition(), Dummy, Dummy,
   3804             CurrentSelect->getName(), CurrentSelect, CurrentSelect);
   3805         Map[Current] = Select;
   3806         ST.insertNewSelect(Select);
   3807         // We are interested in True and False values.
   3808         Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getTrueValue());
   3809         Worklist.push_back(CurrentSelect->getFalseValue());
   3810       } else {
   3811         // It must be a Phi node then.
   3812         PHINode *CurrentPhi = cast<PHINode>(Current);
   3813         unsigned PredCount = CurrentPhi->getNumIncomingValues();
   3814         PHINode *PHI =
   3815             PHINode::Create(CommonType, PredCount, "sunk_phi", CurrentPhi);
   3816         Map[Current] = PHI;
   3817         ST.insertNewPhi(PHI);
   3818         append_range(Worklist, CurrentPhi->incoming_values());
   3819       }
   3820     }
   3821   }
   3822 
   3823   bool addrModeCombiningAllowed() {
   3824     if (DisableComplexAddrModes)
   3825       return false;
   3826     switch (DifferentField) {
   3827     default:
   3828       return false;
   3829     case ExtAddrMode::BaseRegField:
   3830       return AddrSinkCombineBaseReg;
   3831     case ExtAddrMode::BaseGVField:
   3832       return AddrSinkCombineBaseGV;
   3833     case ExtAddrMode::BaseOffsField:
   3834       return AddrSinkCombineBaseOffs;
   3835     case ExtAddrMode::ScaledRegField:
   3836       return AddrSinkCombineScaledReg;
   3837     }
   3838   }
   3839 };
   3840 } // end anonymous namespace
   3841 
   3842 /// Try adding ScaleReg*Scale to the current addressing mode.
   3843 /// Return true and update AddrMode if this addr mode is legal for the target,
   3844 /// false if not.
   3845 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchScaledValue(Value *ScaleReg, int64_t Scale,
   3846                                              unsigned Depth) {
   3847   // If Scale is 1, then this is the same as adding ScaleReg to the addressing
   3848   // mode.  Just process that directly.
   3849   if (Scale == 1)
   3850     return matchAddr(ScaleReg, Depth);
   3851 
   3852   // If the scale is 0, it takes nothing to add this.
   3853   if (Scale == 0)
   3854     return true;
   3855 
   3856   // If we already have a scale of this value, we can add to it, otherwise, we
   3857   // need an available scale field.
   3858   if (AddrMode.Scale != 0 && AddrMode.ScaledReg != ScaleReg)
   3859     return false;
   3860 
   3861   ExtAddrMode TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
   3862 
   3863   // Add scale to turn X*4+X*3 -> X*7.  This could also do things like
   3864   // [A+B + A*7] -> [B+A*8].
   3865   TestAddrMode.Scale += Scale;
   3866   TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = ScaleReg;
   3867 
   3868   // If the new address isn't legal, bail out.
   3869   if (!TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
   3870     return false;
   3871 
   3872   // It was legal, so commit it.
   3873   AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
   3874 
   3875   // Okay, we decided that we can add ScaleReg+Scale to AddrMode.  Check now
   3876   // to see if ScaleReg is actually X+C.  If so, we can turn this into adding
   3877   // X*Scale + C*Scale to addr mode. If we found available IV increment, do not
   3878   // go any further: we can reuse it and cannot eliminate it.
   3879   ConstantInt *CI = nullptr; Value *AddLHS = nullptr;
   3880   if (isa<Instruction>(ScaleReg) && // not a constant expr.
   3881       match(ScaleReg, m_Add(m_Value(AddLHS), m_ConstantInt(CI))) &&
   3882       !isIVIncrement(ScaleReg, &LI) && CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
   3883     TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
   3884     TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = AddLHS;
   3885     TestAddrMode.BaseOffs += CI->getSExtValue() * TestAddrMode.Scale;
   3886 
   3887     // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it and remember that we folded
   3888     // this instruction.
   3889     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace)) {
   3890       AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(ScaleReg));
   3891       AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
   3892       return true;
   3893     }
   3894     // Restore status quo.
   3895     TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
   3896   }
   3897 
   3898   // If this is an add recurrence with a constant step, return the increment
   3899   // instruction and the canonicalized step.
   3900   auto GetConstantStep = [this](const Value * V)
   3901       ->Optional<std::pair<Instruction *, APInt> > {
   3902     auto *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V);
   3903     if (!PN)
   3904       return None;
   3905     auto IVInc = getIVIncrement(PN, &LI);
   3906     if (!IVInc)
   3907       return None;
   3908     // TODO: The result of the intrinsics above is two-compliment. However when
   3909     // IV inc is expressed as add or sub, iv.next is potentially a poison value.
   3910     // If it has nuw or nsw flags, we need to make sure that these flags are
   3911     // inferrable at the point of memory instruction. Otherwise we are replacing
   3912     // well-defined two-compliment computation with poison. Currently, to avoid
   3913     // potentially complex analysis needed to prove this, we reject such cases.
   3914     if (auto *OIVInc = dyn_cast<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(IVInc->first))
   3915       if (OIVInc->hasNoSignedWrap() || OIVInc->hasNoUnsignedWrap())
   3916         return None;
   3917     if (auto *ConstantStep = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IVInc->second))
   3918       return std::make_pair(IVInc->first, ConstantStep->getValue());
   3919     return None;
   3920   };
   3921 
   3922   // Try to account for the following special case:
   3923   // 1. ScaleReg is an inductive variable;
   3924   // 2. We use it with non-zero offset;
   3925   // 3. IV's increment is available at the point of memory instruction.
   3926   //
   3927   // In this case, we may reuse the IV increment instead of the IV Phi to
   3928   // achieve the following advantages:
   3929   // 1. If IV step matches the offset, we will have no need in the offset;
   3930   // 2. Even if they don't match, we will reduce the overlap of living IV
   3931   //    and IV increment, that will potentially lead to better register
   3932   //    assignment.
   3933   if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
   3934     if (auto IVStep = GetConstantStep(ScaleReg)) {
   3935       Instruction *IVInc = IVStep->first;
   3936       // The following assert is important to ensure a lack of infinite loops.
   3937       // This transforms is (intentionally) the inverse of the one just above.
   3938       // If they don't agree on the definition of an increment, we'd alternate
   3939       // back and forth indefinitely.
   3940       assert(isIVIncrement(IVInc, &LI) && "implied by GetConstantStep");
   3941       APInt Step = IVStep->second;
   3942       APInt Offset = Step * AddrMode.Scale;
   3943       if (Offset.isSignedIntN(64)) {
   3944         TestAddrMode.InBounds = false;
   3945         TestAddrMode.ScaledReg = IVInc;
   3946         TestAddrMode.BaseOffs -= Offset.getLimitedValue();
   3947         // If this addressing mode is legal, commit it..
   3948         // (Note that we defer the (expensive) domtree base legality check
   3949         // to the very last possible point.)
   3950         if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, TestAddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace) &&
   3951             getDTFn().dominates(IVInc, MemoryInst)) {
   3952           AddrModeInsts.push_back(cast<Instruction>(IVInc));
   3953           AddrMode = TestAddrMode;
   3954           return true;
   3955         }
   3956         // Restore status quo.
   3957         TestAddrMode = AddrMode;
   3958       }
   3959     }
   3960   }
   3961 
   3962   // Otherwise, just return what we have.
   3963   return true;
   3964 }
   3965 
   3966 /// This is a little filter, which returns true if an addressing computation
   3967 /// involving I might be folded into a load/store accessing it.
   3968 /// This doesn't need to be perfect, but needs to accept at least
   3969 /// the set of instructions that MatchOperationAddr can.
   3970 static bool MightBeFoldableInst(Instruction *I) {
   3971   switch (I->getOpcode()) {
   3972   case Instruction::BitCast:
   3973   case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast:
   3974     // Don't touch identity bitcasts.
   3975     if (I->getType() == I->getOperand(0)->getType())
   3976       return false;
   3977     return I->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy();
   3978   case Instruction::PtrToInt:
   3979     // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
   3980     return true;
   3981   case Instruction::IntToPtr:
   3982     // We know the input is intptr_t, so this is foldable.
   3983     return true;
   3984   case Instruction::Add:
   3985     return true;
   3986   case Instruction::Mul:
   3987   case Instruction::Shl:
   3988     // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
   3989     return isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
   3990   case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
   3991     return true;
   3992   default:
   3993     return false;
   3994   }
   3995 }
   3996 
   3997 /// Check whether or not \p Val is a legal instruction for \p TLI.
   3998 /// \note \p Val is assumed to be the product of some type promotion.
   3999 /// Therefore if \p Val has an undefined state in \p TLI, this is assumed
   4000 /// to be legal, as the non-promoted value would have had the same state.
   4001 static bool isPromotedInstructionLegal(const TargetLowering &TLI,
   4002                                        const DataLayout &DL, Value *Val) {
   4003   Instruction *PromotedInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val);
   4004   if (!PromotedInst)
   4005     return false;
   4006   int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(PromotedInst->getOpcode());
   4007   // If the ISDOpcode is undefined, it was undefined before the promotion.
   4008   if (!ISDOpcode)
   4009     return true;
   4010   // Otherwise, check if the promoted instruction is legal or not.
   4011   return TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
   4012       ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, PromotedInst->getType()));
   4013 }
   4014 
   4015 namespace {
   4016 
   4017 /// Hepler class to perform type promotion.
   4018 class TypePromotionHelper {
   4019   /// Utility function to add a promoted instruction \p ExtOpnd to
   4020   /// \p PromotedInsts and record the type of extension we have seen.
   4021   static void addPromotedInst(InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   4022                               Instruction *ExtOpnd,
   4023                               bool IsSExt) {
   4024     ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
   4025     InstrToOrigTy::iterator It = PromotedInsts.find(ExtOpnd);
   4026     if (It != PromotedInsts.end()) {
   4027       // If the new extension is same as original, the information in
   4028       // PromotedInsts[ExtOpnd] is still correct.
   4029       if (It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
   4030         return;
   4031 
   4032       // Now the new extension is different from old extension, we make
   4033       // the type information invalid by setting extension type to
   4034       // BothExtension.
   4035       ExtTy = BothExtension;
   4036     }
   4037     PromotedInsts[ExtOpnd] = TypeIsSExt(ExtOpnd->getType(), ExtTy);
   4038   }
   4039 
   4040   /// Utility function to query the original type of instruction \p Opnd
   4041   /// with a matched extension type. If the extension doesn't match, we
   4042   /// cannot use the information we had on the original type.
   4043   /// BothExtension doesn't match any extension type.
   4044   static const Type *getOrigType(const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   4045                                  Instruction *Opnd,
   4046                                  bool IsSExt) {
   4047     ExtType ExtTy = IsSExt ? SignExtension : ZeroExtension;
   4048     InstrToOrigTy::const_iterator It = PromotedInsts.find(Opnd);
   4049     if (It != PromotedInsts.end() && It->second.getInt() == ExtTy)
   4050       return It->second.getPointer();
   4051     return nullptr;
   4052   }
   4053 
   4054   /// Utility function to check whether or not a sign or zero extension
   4055   /// of \p Inst with \p ConsideredExtType can be moved through \p Inst by
   4056   /// either using the operands of \p Inst or promoting \p Inst.
   4057   /// The type of the extension is defined by \p IsSExt.
   4058   /// In other words, check if:
   4059   /// ext (Ty Inst opnd1 opnd2 ... opndN) to ConsideredExtType.
   4060   /// #1 Promotion applies:
   4061   /// ConsideredExtType Inst (ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType, ...).
   4062   /// #2 Operand reuses:
   4063   /// ext opnd1 to ConsideredExtType.
   4064   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
   4065   static bool canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst, Type *ConsideredExtType,
   4066                             const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, bool IsSExt);
   4067 
   4068   /// Utility function to determine if \p OpIdx should be promoted when
   4069   /// promoting \p Inst.
   4070   static bool shouldExtOperand(const Instruction *Inst, int OpIdx) {
   4071     return !(isa<SelectInst>(Inst) && OpIdx == 0);
   4072   }
   4073 
   4074   /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
   4075   /// operand is a promotable trunc or sext or zext.
   4076   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
   4077   /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all instructions
   4078   /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
   4079   /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
   4080   /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
   4081   /// Should never be called directly.
   4082   /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
   4083   static Value *promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
   4084       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4085       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4086       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4087       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI);
   4088 
   4089   /// Utility function to promote the operand of \p Ext when this
   4090   /// operand is promotable and is not a supported trunc or sext.
   4091   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
   4092   /// \p CreatedInstsCost[out] contains the cost of all the instructions
   4093   /// created to promote the operand of Ext.
   4094   /// Newly added extensions are inserted in \p Exts.
   4095   /// Newly added truncates are inserted in \p Truncs.
   4096   /// Should never be called directly.
   4097   /// \return The promoted value which is used instead of Ext.
   4098   static Value *promoteOperandForOther(Instruction *Ext,
   4099                                        TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4100                                        InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   4101                                        unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4102                                        SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4103                                        SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
   4104                                        const TargetLowering &TLI, bool IsSExt);
   4105 
   4106   /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
   4107   static Value *signExtendOperandForOther(
   4108       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4109       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4110       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4111       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   4112     return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
   4113                                   Exts, Truncs, TLI, true);
   4114   }
   4115 
   4116   /// \see promoteOperandForOther.
   4117   static Value *zeroExtendOperandForOther(
   4118       Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4119       InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4120       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4121       SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   4122     return promoteOperandForOther(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost,
   4123                                   Exts, Truncs, TLI, false);
   4124   }
   4125 
   4126 public:
   4127   /// Type for the utility function that promotes the operand of Ext.
   4128   using Action = Value *(*)(Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4129                             InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   4130                             unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4131                             SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4132                             SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs,
   4133                             const TargetLowering &TLI);
   4134 
   4135   /// Given a sign/zero extend instruction \p Ext, return the appropriate
   4136   /// action to promote the operand of \p Ext instead of using Ext.
   4137   /// \return NULL if no promotable action is possible with the current
   4138   /// sign extension.
   4139   /// \p InsertedInsts keeps track of all the instructions inserted by the
   4140   /// other CodeGenPrepare optimizations. This information is important
   4141   /// because we do not want to promote these instructions as CodeGenPrepare
   4142   /// will reinsert them later. Thus creating an infinite loop: create/remove.
   4143   /// \p PromotedInsts maps the instructions to their type before promotion.
   4144   static Action getAction(Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
   4145                           const TargetLowering &TLI,
   4146                           const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts);
   4147 };
   4148 
   4149 } // end anonymous namespace
   4150 
   4151 bool TypePromotionHelper::canGetThrough(const Instruction *Inst,
   4152                                         Type *ConsideredExtType,
   4153                                         const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts,
   4154                                         bool IsSExt) {
   4155   // The promotion helper does not know how to deal with vector types yet.
   4156   // To be able to fix that, we would need to fix the places where we
   4157   // statically extend, e.g., constants and such.
   4158   if (Inst->getType()->isVectorTy())
   4159     return false;
   4160 
   4161   // We can always get through zext.
   4162   if (isa<ZExtInst>(Inst))
   4163     return true;
   4164 
   4165   // sext(sext) is ok too.
   4166   if (IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Inst))
   4167     return true;
   4168 
   4169   // We can get through binary operator, if it is legal. In other words, the
   4170   // binary operator must have a nuw or nsw flag.
   4171   const BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Inst);
   4172   if (isa_and_nonnull<OverflowingBinaryOperator>(BinOp) &&
   4173       ((!IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoUnsignedWrap()) ||
   4174        (IsSExt && BinOp->hasNoSignedWrap())))
   4175     return true;
   4176 
   4177   // ext(and(opnd, cst)) --> and(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
   4178   if ((Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
   4179        Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or))
   4180     return true;
   4181 
   4182   // ext(xor(opnd, cst)) --> xor(ext(opnd), ext(cst))
   4183   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor) {
   4184     const ConstantInt *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
   4185     // Make sure it is not a NOT.
   4186     if (Cst && !Cst->getValue().isAllOnesValue())
   4187       return true;
   4188   }
   4189 
   4190   // zext(shrl(opnd, cst)) --> shrl(zext(opnd), zext(cst))
   4191   // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
   4192   //     zext i32 (shrl i8 %val, 12)  -->  shrl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
   4193   //          poisoned value                    regular value
   4194   // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
   4195   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && !IsSExt)
   4196     return true;
   4197 
   4198   // and(ext(shl(opnd, cst)), cst) --> and(shl(ext(opnd), ext(cst)), cst)
   4199   // It may change a poisoned value into a regular value, like
   4200   //     zext i32 (shl i8 %val, 12)  -->  shl i32 (zext i8 %val), 12
   4201   //          poisoned value                    regular value
   4202   // It should be OK since undef covers valid value.
   4203   if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl && Inst->hasOneUse()) {
   4204     const auto *ExtInst = cast<const Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
   4205     if (ExtInst->hasOneUse()) {
   4206       const auto *AndInst = dyn_cast<const Instruction>(*ExtInst->user_begin());
   4207       if (AndInst && AndInst->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
   4208         const auto *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AndInst->getOperand(1));
   4209         if (Cst &&
   4210             Cst->getValue().isIntN(Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth()))
   4211           return true;
   4212       }
   4213     }
   4214   }
   4215 
   4216   // Check if we can do the following simplification.
   4217   // ext(trunc(opnd)) --> ext(opnd)
   4218   if (!isa<TruncInst>(Inst))
   4219     return false;
   4220 
   4221   Value *OpndVal = Inst->getOperand(0);
   4222   // Check if we can use this operand in the extension.
   4223   // If the type is larger than the result type of the extension, we cannot.
   4224   if (!OpndVal->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
   4225       OpndVal->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
   4226           ConsideredExtType->getIntegerBitWidth())
   4227     return false;
   4228 
   4229   // If the operand of the truncate is not an instruction, we will not have
   4230   // any information on the dropped bits.
   4231   // (Actually we could for constant but it is not worth the extra logic).
   4232   Instruction *Opnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OpndVal);
   4233   if (!Opnd)
   4234     return false;
   4235 
   4236   // Check if the source of the type is narrow enough.
   4237   // I.e., check that trunc just drops extended bits of the same kind of
   4238   // the extension.
   4239   // #1 get the type of the operand and check the kind of the extended bits.
   4240   const Type *OpndType = getOrigType(PromotedInsts, Opnd, IsSExt);
   4241   if (OpndType)
   4242     ;
   4243   else if ((IsSExt && isa<SExtInst>(Opnd)) || (!IsSExt && isa<ZExtInst>(Opnd)))
   4244     OpndType = Opnd->getOperand(0)->getType();
   4245   else
   4246     return false;
   4247 
   4248   // #2 check that the truncate just drops extended bits.
   4249   return Inst->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >=
   4250          OpndType->getIntegerBitWidth();
   4251 }
   4252 
   4253 TypePromotionHelper::Action TypePromotionHelper::getAction(
   4254     Instruction *Ext, const SetOfInstrs &InsertedInsts,
   4255     const TargetLowering &TLI, const InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts) {
   4256   assert((isa<SExtInst>(Ext) || isa<ZExtInst>(Ext)) &&
   4257          "Unexpected instruction type");
   4258   Instruction *ExtOpnd = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
   4259   Type *ExtTy = Ext->getType();
   4260   bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(Ext);
   4261   // If the operand of the extension is not an instruction, we cannot
   4262   // get through.
   4263   // If it, check we can get through.
   4264   if (!ExtOpnd || !canGetThrough(ExtOpnd, ExtTy, PromotedInsts, IsSExt))
   4265     return nullptr;
   4266 
   4267   // Do not promote if the operand has been added by codegenprepare.
   4268   // Otherwise, it means we are undoing an optimization that is likely to be
   4269   // redone, thus causing potential infinite loop.
   4270   if (isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) && InsertedInsts.count(ExtOpnd))
   4271     return nullptr;
   4272 
   4273   // SExt or Trunc instructions.
   4274   // Return the related handler.
   4275   if (isa<SExtInst>(ExtOpnd) || isa<TruncInst>(ExtOpnd) ||
   4276       isa<ZExtInst>(ExtOpnd))
   4277     return promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt;
   4278 
   4279   // Regular instruction.
   4280   // Abort early if we will have to insert non-free instructions.
   4281   if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse() && !TLI.isTruncateFree(ExtTy, ExtOpnd->getType()))
   4282     return nullptr;
   4283   return IsSExt ? signExtendOperandForOther : zeroExtendOperandForOther;
   4284 }
   4285 
   4286 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForTruncAndAnyExt(
   4287     Instruction *SExt, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4288     InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4289     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4290     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   4291   // By construction, the operand of SExt is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
   4292   // get through it and this method should not be called.
   4293   Instruction *SExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(SExt->getOperand(0));
   4294   Value *ExtVal = SExt;
   4295   bool HasMergedNonFreeExt = false;
   4296   if (isa<ZExtInst>(SExtOpnd)) {
   4297     // Replace s|zext(zext(opnd))
   4298     // => zext(opnd).
   4299     HasMergedNonFreeExt = !TLI.isExtFree(SExtOpnd);
   4300     Value *ZExt =
   4301         TPT.createZExt(SExt, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0), SExt->getType());
   4302     TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(SExt, ZExt);
   4303     TPT.eraseInstruction(SExt);
   4304     ExtVal = ZExt;
   4305   } else {
   4306     // Replace z|sext(trunc(opnd)) or sext(sext(opnd))
   4307     // => z|sext(opnd).
   4308     TPT.setOperand(SExt, 0, SExtOpnd->getOperand(0));
   4309   }
   4310   CreatedInstsCost = 0;
   4311 
   4312   // Remove dead code.
   4313   if (SExtOpnd->use_empty())
   4314     TPT.eraseInstruction(SExtOpnd);
   4315 
   4316   // Check if the extension is still needed.
   4317   Instruction *ExtInst = dyn_cast<Instruction>(ExtVal);
   4318   if (!ExtInst || ExtInst->getType() != ExtInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
   4319     if (ExtInst) {
   4320       if (Exts)
   4321         Exts->push_back(ExtInst);
   4322       CreatedInstsCost = !TLI.isExtFree(ExtInst) && !HasMergedNonFreeExt;
   4323     }
   4324     return ExtVal;
   4325   }
   4326 
   4327   // At this point we have: ext ty opnd to ty.
   4328   // Reassign the uses of ExtInst to the opnd and remove ExtInst.
   4329   Value *NextVal = ExtInst->getOperand(0);
   4330   TPT.eraseInstruction(ExtInst, NextVal);
   4331   return NextVal;
   4332 }
   4333 
   4334 Value *TypePromotionHelper::promoteOperandForOther(
   4335     Instruction *Ext, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   4336     InstrToOrigTy &PromotedInsts, unsigned &CreatedInstsCost,
   4337     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Exts,
   4338     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> *Truncs, const TargetLowering &TLI,
   4339     bool IsSExt) {
   4340   // By construction, the operand of Ext is an instruction. Otherwise we cannot
   4341   // get through it and this method should not be called.
   4342   Instruction *ExtOpnd = cast<Instruction>(Ext->getOperand(0));
   4343   CreatedInstsCost = 0;
   4344   if (!ExtOpnd->hasOneUse()) {
   4345     // ExtOpnd will be promoted.
   4346     // All its uses, but Ext, will need to use a truncated value of the
   4347     // promoted version.
   4348     // Create the truncate now.
   4349     Value *Trunc = TPT.createTrunc(Ext, ExtOpnd->getType());
   4350     if (Instruction *ITrunc = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Trunc)) {
   4351       // Insert it just after the definition.
   4352       ITrunc->moveAfter(ExtOpnd);
   4353       if (Truncs)
   4354         Truncs->push_back(ITrunc);
   4355     }
   4356 
   4357     TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(ExtOpnd, Trunc);
   4358     // Restore the operand of Ext (which has been replaced by the previous call
   4359     // to replaceAllUsesWith) to avoid creating a cycle trunc <-> sext.
   4360     TPT.setOperand(Ext, 0, ExtOpnd);
   4361   }
   4362 
   4363   // Get through the Instruction:
   4364   // 1. Update its type.
   4365   // 2. Replace the uses of Ext by Inst.
   4366   // 3. Extend each operand that needs to be extended.
   4367 
   4368   // Remember the original type of the instruction before promotion.
   4369   // This is useful to know that the high bits are sign extended bits.
   4370   addPromotedInst(PromotedInsts, ExtOpnd, IsSExt);
   4371   // Step #1.
   4372   TPT.mutateType(ExtOpnd, Ext->getType());
   4373   // Step #2.
   4374   TPT.replaceAllUsesWith(Ext, ExtOpnd);
   4375   // Step #3.
   4376   Instruction *ExtForOpnd = Ext;
   4377 
   4378   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Propagate Ext to operands\n");
   4379   for (int OpIdx = 0, EndOpIdx = ExtOpnd->getNumOperands(); OpIdx != EndOpIdx;
   4380        ++OpIdx) {
   4381     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Operand:\n" << *(ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)) << '\n');
   4382     if (ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx)->getType() == Ext->getType() ||
   4383         !shouldExtOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx)) {
   4384       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "No need to propagate\n");
   4385       continue;
   4386     }
   4387     // Check if we can statically extend the operand.
   4388     Value *Opnd = ExtOpnd->getOperand(OpIdx);
   4389     if (const ConstantInt *Cst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Opnd)) {
   4390       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
   4391       unsigned BitWidth = Ext->getType()->getIntegerBitWidth();
   4392       APInt CstVal = IsSExt ? Cst->getValue().sext(BitWidth)
   4393                             : Cst->getValue().zext(BitWidth);
   4394       TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ConstantInt::get(Ext->getType(), CstVal));
   4395       continue;
   4396     }
   4397     // UndefValue are typed, so we have to statically sign extend them.
   4398     if (isa<UndefValue>(Opnd)) {
   4399       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Statically extend\n");
   4400       TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, UndefValue::get(Ext->getType()));
   4401       continue;
   4402     }
   4403 
   4404     // Otherwise we have to explicitly sign extend the operand.
   4405     // Check if Ext was reused to extend an operand.
   4406     if (!ExtForOpnd) {
   4407       // If yes, create a new one.
   4408       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "More operands to ext\n");
   4409       Value *ValForExtOpnd = IsSExt ? TPT.createSExt(Ext, Opnd, Ext->getType())
   4410         : TPT.createZExt(Ext, Opnd, Ext->getType());
   4411       if (!isa<Instruction>(ValForExtOpnd)) {
   4412         TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ValForExtOpnd);
   4413         continue;
   4414       }
   4415       ExtForOpnd = cast<Instruction>(ValForExtOpnd);
   4416     }
   4417     if (Exts)
   4418       Exts->push_back(ExtForOpnd);
   4419     TPT.setOperand(ExtForOpnd, 0, Opnd);
   4420 
   4421     // Move the sign extension before the insertion point.
   4422     TPT.moveBefore(ExtForOpnd, ExtOpnd);
   4423     TPT.setOperand(ExtOpnd, OpIdx, ExtForOpnd);
   4424     CreatedInstsCost += !TLI.isExtFree(ExtForOpnd);
   4425     // If more sext are required, new instructions will have to be created.
   4426     ExtForOpnd = nullptr;
   4427   }
   4428   if (ExtForOpnd == Ext) {
   4429     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Extension is useless now\n");
   4430     TPT.eraseInstruction(Ext);
   4431   }
   4432   return ExtOpnd;
   4433 }
   4434 
   4435 /// Check whether or not promoting an instruction to a wider type is profitable.
   4436 /// \p NewCost gives the cost of extension instructions created by the
   4437 /// promotion.
   4438 /// \p OldCost gives the cost of extension instructions before the promotion
   4439 /// plus the number of instructions that have been
   4440 /// matched in the addressing mode the promotion.
   4441 /// \p PromotedOperand is the value that has been promoted.
   4442 /// \return True if the promotion is profitable, false otherwise.
   4443 bool AddressingModeMatcher::isPromotionProfitable(
   4444     unsigned NewCost, unsigned OldCost, Value *PromotedOperand) const {
   4445   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "OldCost: " << OldCost << "\tNewCost: " << NewCost
   4446                     << '\n');
   4447   // The cost of the new extensions is greater than the cost of the
   4448   // old extension plus what we folded.
   4449   // This is not profitable.
   4450   if (NewCost > OldCost)
   4451     return false;
   4452   if (NewCost < OldCost)
   4453     return true;
   4454   // The promotion is neutral but it may help folding the sign extension in
   4455   // loads for instance.
   4456   // Check that we did not create an illegal instruction.
   4457   return isPromotedInstructionLegal(TLI, DL, PromotedOperand);
   4458 }
   4459 
   4460 /// Given an instruction or constant expr, see if we can fold the operation
   4461 /// into the addressing mode. If so, update the addressing mode and return
   4462 /// true, otherwise return false without modifying AddrMode.
   4463 /// If \p MovedAway is not NULL, it contains the information of whether or
   4464 /// not AddrInst has to be folded into the addressing mode on success.
   4465 /// If \p MovedAway == true, \p AddrInst will not be part of the addressing
   4466 /// because it has been moved away.
   4467 /// Thus AddrInst must not be added in the matched instructions.
   4468 /// This state can happen when AddrInst is a sext, since it may be moved away.
   4469 /// Therefore, AddrInst may not be valid when MovedAway is true and it must
   4470 /// not be referenced anymore.
   4471 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchOperationAddr(User *AddrInst, unsigned Opcode,
   4472                                                unsigned Depth,
   4473                                                bool *MovedAway) {
   4474   // Avoid exponential behavior on extremely deep expression trees.
   4475   if (Depth >= 5) return false;
   4476 
   4477   // By default, all matched instructions stay in place.
   4478   if (MovedAway)
   4479     *MovedAway = false;
   4480 
   4481   switch (Opcode) {
   4482   case Instruction::PtrToInt:
   4483     // PtrToInt is always a noop, as we know that the int type is pointer sized.
   4484     return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
   4485   case Instruction::IntToPtr: {
   4486     auto AS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
   4487     auto PtrTy = MVT::getIntegerVT(DL.getPointerSizeInBits(AS));
   4488     // This inttoptr is a no-op if the integer type is pointer sized.
   4489     if (TLI.getValueType(DL, AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()) == PtrTy)
   4490       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
   4491     return false;
   4492   }
   4493   case Instruction::BitCast:
   4494     // BitCast is always a noop, and we can handle it as long as it is
   4495     // int->int or pointer->pointer (we don't want int<->fp or something).
   4496     if (AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy() &&
   4497         // Don't touch identity bitcasts.  These were probably put here by LSR,
   4498         // and we don't want to mess around with them.  Assume it knows what it
   4499         // is doing.
   4500         AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType() != AddrInst->getType())
   4501       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
   4502     return false;
   4503   case Instruction::AddrSpaceCast: {
   4504     unsigned SrcAS
   4505       = AddrInst->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
   4506     unsigned DestAS = AddrInst->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace();
   4507     if (TLI.getTargetMachine().isNoopAddrSpaceCast(SrcAS, DestAS))
   4508       return matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth);
   4509     return false;
   4510   }
   4511   case Instruction::Add: {
   4512     // Check to see if we can merge in the RHS then the LHS.  If so, we win.
   4513     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
   4514     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
   4515     // Start a transaction at this point.
   4516     // The LHS may match but not the RHS.
   4517     // Therefore, we need a higher level restoration point to undo partially
   4518     // matched operation.
   4519     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   4520         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   4521 
   4522     AddrMode.InBounds = false;
   4523     if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(1), Depth+1) &&
   4524         matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth+1))
   4525       return true;
   4526 
   4527     // Restore the old addr mode info.
   4528     AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4529     AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4530     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4531 
   4532     // Otherwise this was over-aggressive.  Try merging in the LHS then the RHS.
   4533     if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth+1) &&
   4534         matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(1), Depth+1))
   4535       return true;
   4536 
   4537     // Otherwise we definitely can't merge the ADD in.
   4538     AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4539     AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4540     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4541     break;
   4542   }
   4543   //case Instruction::Or:
   4544   // TODO: We can handle "Or Val, Imm" iff this OR is equivalent to an ADD.
   4545   //break;
   4546   case Instruction::Mul:
   4547   case Instruction::Shl: {
   4548     // Can only handle X*C and X << C.
   4549     AddrMode.InBounds = false;
   4550     ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(1));
   4551     if (!RHS || RHS->getBitWidth() > 64)
   4552       return false;
   4553     int64_t Scale = RHS->getSExtValue();
   4554     if (Opcode == Instruction::Shl)
   4555       Scale = 1LL << Scale;
   4556 
   4557     return matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Scale, Depth);
   4558   }
   4559   case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
   4560     // Scan the GEP.  We check it if it contains constant offsets and at most
   4561     // one variable offset.
   4562     int VariableOperand = -1;
   4563     unsigned VariableScale = 0;
   4564 
   4565     int64_t ConstantOffset = 0;
   4566     gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(AddrInst);
   4567     for (unsigned i = 1, e = AddrInst->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
   4568       if (StructType *STy = GTI.getStructTypeOrNull()) {
   4569         const StructLayout *SL = DL.getStructLayout(STy);
   4570         unsigned Idx =
   4571           cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
   4572         ConstantOffset += SL->getElementOffset(Idx);
   4573       } else {
   4574         TypeSize TS = DL.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
   4575         if (TS.isNonZero()) {
   4576           // The optimisations below currently only work for fixed offsets.
   4577           if (TS.isScalable())
   4578             return false;
   4579           int64_t TypeSize = TS.getFixedSize();
   4580           if (ConstantInt *CI =
   4581                   dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AddrInst->getOperand(i))) {
   4582             const APInt &CVal = CI->getValue();
   4583             if (CVal.getMinSignedBits() <= 64) {
   4584               ConstantOffset += CVal.getSExtValue() * TypeSize;
   4585               continue;
   4586             }
   4587           }
   4588           // We only allow one variable index at the moment.
   4589           if (VariableOperand != -1)
   4590             return false;
   4591 
   4592           // Remember the variable index.
   4593           VariableOperand = i;
   4594           VariableScale = TypeSize;
   4595         }
   4596       }
   4597     }
   4598 
   4599     // A common case is for the GEP to only do a constant offset.  In this case,
   4600     // just add it to the disp field and check validity.
   4601     if (VariableOperand == -1) {
   4602       AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
   4603       if (ConstantOffset == 0 ||
   4604           TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace)) {
   4605         // Check to see if we can fold the base pointer in too.
   4606         if (matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth+1)) {
   4607           if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
   4608             AddrMode.InBounds = false;
   4609           return true;
   4610         }
   4611       } else if (EnableGEPOffsetSplit && isa<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst) &&
   4612                  TLI.shouldConsiderGEPOffsetSplit() && Depth == 0 &&
   4613                  ConstantOffset > 0) {
   4614         // Record GEPs with non-zero offsets as candidates for splitting in the
   4615         // event that the offset cannot fit into the r+i addressing mode.
   4616         // Simple and common case that only one GEP is used in calculating the
   4617         // address for the memory access.
   4618         Value *Base = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
   4619         auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Base);
   4620         auto *GEP = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(AddrInst);
   4621         if (isa<Argument>(Base) || isa<GlobalValue>(Base) ||
   4622             (BaseI && !isa<CastInst>(BaseI) &&
   4623              !isa<GetElementPtrInst>(BaseI))) {
   4624           // Make sure the parent block allows inserting non-PHI instructions
   4625           // before the terminator.
   4626           BasicBlock *Parent =
   4627               BaseI ? BaseI->getParent() : &GEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
   4628           if (!Parent->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
   4629             LargeOffsetGEP = std::make_pair(GEP, ConstantOffset);
   4630         }
   4631       }
   4632       AddrMode.BaseOffs -= ConstantOffset;
   4633       return false;
   4634     }
   4635 
   4636     // Save the valid addressing mode in case we can't match.
   4637     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
   4638     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
   4639 
   4640     // See if the scale and offset amount is valid for this target.
   4641     AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
   4642     if (!cast<GEPOperator>(AddrInst)->isInBounds())
   4643       AddrMode.InBounds = false;
   4644 
   4645     // Match the base operand of the GEP.
   4646     if (!matchAddr(AddrInst->getOperand(0), Depth+1)) {
   4647       // If it couldn't be matched, just stuff the value in a register.
   4648       if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
   4649         AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4650         AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4651         return false;
   4652       }
   4653       AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
   4654       AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
   4655     }
   4656 
   4657     // Match the remaining variable portion of the GEP.
   4658     if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand), VariableScale,
   4659                           Depth)) {
   4660       // If it couldn't be matched, try stuffing the base into a register
   4661       // instead of matching it, and retrying the match of the scale.
   4662       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4663       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4664       if (AddrMode.HasBaseReg)
   4665         return false;
   4666       AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
   4667       AddrMode.BaseReg = AddrInst->getOperand(0);
   4668       AddrMode.BaseOffs += ConstantOffset;
   4669       if (!matchScaledValue(AddrInst->getOperand(VariableOperand),
   4670                             VariableScale, Depth)) {
   4671         // If even that didn't work, bail.
   4672         AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4673         AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4674         return false;
   4675       }
   4676     }
   4677 
   4678     return true;
   4679   }
   4680   case Instruction::SExt:
   4681   case Instruction::ZExt: {
   4682     Instruction *Ext = dyn_cast<Instruction>(AddrInst);
   4683     if (!Ext)
   4684       return false;
   4685 
   4686     // Try to move this ext out of the way of the addressing mode.
   4687     // Ask for a method for doing so.
   4688     TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
   4689         TypePromotionHelper::getAction(Ext, InsertedInsts, TLI, PromotedInsts);
   4690     if (!TPH)
   4691       return false;
   4692 
   4693     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   4694         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   4695     unsigned CreatedInstsCost = 0;
   4696     unsigned ExtCost = !TLI.isExtFree(Ext);
   4697     Value *PromotedOperand =
   4698         TPH(Ext, TPT, PromotedInsts, CreatedInstsCost, nullptr, nullptr, TLI);
   4699     // SExt has been moved away.
   4700     // Thus either it will be rematched later in the recursive calls or it is
   4701     // gone. Anyway, we must not fold it into the addressing mode at this point.
   4702     // E.g.,
   4703     // op = add opnd, 1
   4704     // idx = ext op
   4705     // addr = gep base, idx
   4706     // is now:
   4707     // promotedOpnd = ext opnd            <- no match here
   4708     // op = promoted_add promotedOpnd, 1  <- match (later in recursive calls)
   4709     // addr = gep base, op                <- match
   4710     if (MovedAway)
   4711       *MovedAway = true;
   4712 
   4713     assert(PromotedOperand &&
   4714            "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
   4715 
   4716     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
   4717     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
   4718 
   4719     if (!matchAddr(PromotedOperand, Depth) ||
   4720         // The total of the new cost is equal to the cost of the created
   4721         // instructions.
   4722         // The total of the old cost is equal to the cost of the extension plus
   4723         // what we have saved in the addressing mode.
   4724         !isPromotionProfitable(CreatedInstsCost,
   4725                                ExtCost + (AddrModeInsts.size() - OldSize),
   4726                                PromotedOperand)) {
   4727       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4728       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4729       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sign extension does not pay off: rollback\n");
   4730       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4731       return false;
   4732     }
   4733     return true;
   4734   }
   4735   }
   4736   return false;
   4737 }
   4738 
   4739 /// If we can, try to add the value of 'Addr' into the current addressing mode.
   4740 /// If Addr can't be added to AddrMode this returns false and leaves AddrMode
   4741 /// unmodified. This assumes that Addr is either a pointer type or intptr_t
   4742 /// for the target.
   4743 ///
   4744 bool AddressingModeMatcher::matchAddr(Value *Addr, unsigned Depth) {
   4745   // Start a transaction at this point that we will rollback if the matching
   4746   // fails.
   4747   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   4748       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   4749   if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Addr)) {
   4750     if (CI->getValue().isSignedIntN(64)) {
   4751       // Fold in immediates if legal for the target.
   4752       AddrMode.BaseOffs += CI->getSExtValue();
   4753       if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
   4754         return true;
   4755       AddrMode.BaseOffs -= CI->getSExtValue();
   4756     }
   4757   } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(Addr)) {
   4758     // If this is a global variable, try to fold it into the addressing mode.
   4759     if (!AddrMode.BaseGV) {
   4760       AddrMode.BaseGV = GV;
   4761       if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
   4762         return true;
   4763       AddrMode.BaseGV = nullptr;
   4764     }
   4765   } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Addr)) {
   4766     ExtAddrMode BackupAddrMode = AddrMode;
   4767     unsigned OldSize = AddrModeInsts.size();
   4768 
   4769     // Check to see if it is possible to fold this operation.
   4770     bool MovedAway = false;
   4771     if (matchOperationAddr(I, I->getOpcode(), Depth, &MovedAway)) {
   4772       // This instruction may have been moved away. If so, there is nothing
   4773       // to check here.
   4774       if (MovedAway)
   4775         return true;
   4776       // Okay, it's possible to fold this.  Check to see if it is actually
   4777       // *profitable* to do so.  We use a simple cost model to avoid increasing
   4778       // register pressure too much.
   4779       if (I->hasOneUse() ||
   4780           isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(I, BackupAddrMode, AddrMode)) {
   4781         AddrModeInsts.push_back(I);
   4782         return true;
   4783       }
   4784 
   4785       // It isn't profitable to do this, roll back.
   4786       //cerr << "NOT FOLDING: " << *I;
   4787       AddrMode = BackupAddrMode;
   4788       AddrModeInsts.resize(OldSize);
   4789       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4790     }
   4791   } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Addr)) {
   4792     if (matchOperationAddr(CE, CE->getOpcode(), Depth))
   4793       return true;
   4794     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4795   } else if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Addr)) {
   4796     // Null pointer gets folded without affecting the addressing mode.
   4797     return true;
   4798   }
   4799 
   4800   // Worse case, the target should support [reg] addressing modes. :)
   4801   if (!AddrMode.HasBaseReg) {
   4802     AddrMode.HasBaseReg = true;
   4803     AddrMode.BaseReg = Addr;
   4804     // Still check for legality in case the target supports [imm] but not [i+r].
   4805     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
   4806       return true;
   4807     AddrMode.HasBaseReg = false;
   4808     AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
   4809   }
   4810 
   4811   // If the base register is already taken, see if we can do [r+r].
   4812   if (AddrMode.Scale == 0) {
   4813     AddrMode.Scale = 1;
   4814     AddrMode.ScaledReg = Addr;
   4815     if (TLI.isLegalAddressingMode(DL, AddrMode, AccessTy, AddrSpace))
   4816       return true;
   4817     AddrMode.Scale = 0;
   4818     AddrMode.ScaledReg = nullptr;
   4819   }
   4820   // Couldn't match.
   4821   TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   4822   return false;
   4823 }
   4824 
   4825 /// Check to see if all uses of OpVal by the specified inline asm call are due
   4826 /// to memory operands. If so, return true, otherwise return false.
   4827 static bool IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CallInst *CI, InlineAsm *IA, Value *OpVal,
   4828                                     const TargetLowering &TLI,
   4829                                     const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI) {
   4830   const Function *F = CI->getFunction();
   4831   TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
   4832       TLI.ParseConstraints(F->getParent()->getDataLayout(), &TRI, *CI);
   4833 
   4834   for (unsigned i = 0, e = TargetConstraints.size(); i != e; ++i) {
   4835     TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo = TargetConstraints[i];
   4836 
   4837     // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
   4838     TLI.ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
   4839 
   4840     // If this asm operand is our Value*, and if it isn't an indirect memory
   4841     // operand, we can't fold it!
   4842     if (OpInfo.CallOperandVal == OpVal &&
   4843         (OpInfo.ConstraintType != TargetLowering::C_Memory ||
   4844          !OpInfo.isIndirect))
   4845       return false;
   4846   }
   4847 
   4848   return true;
   4849 }
   4850 
   4851 // Max number of memory uses to look at before aborting the search to conserve
   4852 // compile time.
   4853 static constexpr int MaxMemoryUsesToScan = 20;
   4854 
   4855 /// Recursively walk all the uses of I until we find a memory use.
   4856 /// If we find an obviously non-foldable instruction, return true.
   4857 /// Add the ultimately found memory instructions to MemoryUses.
   4858 static bool FindAllMemoryUses(
   4859     Instruction *I,
   4860     SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<Instruction *, unsigned>> &MemoryUses,
   4861     SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &ConsideredInsts, const TargetLowering &TLI,
   4862     const TargetRegisterInfo &TRI, bool OptSize, ProfileSummaryInfo *PSI,
   4863     BlockFrequencyInfo *BFI, int SeenInsts = 0) {
   4864   // If we already considered this instruction, we're done.
   4865   if (!ConsideredInsts.insert(I).second)
   4866     return false;
   4867 
   4868   // If this is an obviously unfoldable instruction, bail out.
   4869   if (!MightBeFoldableInst(I))
   4870     return true;
   4871 
   4872   // Loop over all the uses, recursively processing them.
   4873   for (Use &U : I->uses()) {
   4874     // Conservatively return true if we're seeing a large number or a deep chain
   4875     // of users. This avoids excessive compilation times in pathological cases.
   4876     if (SeenInsts++ >= MaxMemoryUsesToScan)
   4877       return true;
   4878 
   4879     Instruction *UserI = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
   4880     if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(UserI)) {
   4881       MemoryUses.push_back(std::make_pair(LI, U.getOperandNo()));
   4882       continue;
   4883     }
   4884 
   4885     if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(UserI)) {
   4886       unsigned opNo = U.getOperandNo();
   4887       if (opNo != StoreInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
   4888         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
   4889       MemoryUses.push_back(std::make_pair(SI, opNo));
   4890       continue;
   4891     }
   4892 
   4893     if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(UserI)) {
   4894       unsigned opNo = U.getOperandNo();
   4895       if (opNo != AtomicRMWInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
   4896         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
   4897       MemoryUses.push_back(std::make_pair(RMW, opNo));
   4898       continue;
   4899     }
   4900 
   4901     if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(UserI)) {
   4902       unsigned opNo = U.getOperandNo();
   4903       if (opNo != AtomicCmpXchgInst::getPointerOperandIndex())
   4904         return true; // Storing addr, not into addr.
   4905       MemoryUses.push_back(std::make_pair(CmpX, opNo));
   4906       continue;
   4907     }
   4908 
   4909     if (CallInst *CI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(UserI)) {
   4910       if (CI->hasFnAttr(Attribute::Cold)) {
   4911         // If this is a cold call, we can sink the addressing calculation into
   4912         // the cold path.  See optimizeCallInst
   4913         bool OptForSize = OptSize ||
   4914           llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(CI->getParent(), PSI, BFI);
   4915         if (!OptForSize)
   4916           continue;
   4917       }
   4918 
   4919       InlineAsm *IA = dyn_cast<InlineAsm>(CI->getCalledOperand());
   4920       if (!IA) return true;
   4921 
   4922       // If this is a memory operand, we're cool, otherwise bail out.
   4923       if (!IsOperandAMemoryOperand(CI, IA, I, TLI, TRI))
   4924         return true;
   4925       continue;
   4926     }
   4927 
   4928     if (FindAllMemoryUses(UserI, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
   4929                           PSI, BFI, SeenInsts))
   4930       return true;
   4931   }
   4932 
   4933   return false;
   4934 }
   4935 
   4936 /// Return true if Val is already known to be live at the use site that we're
   4937 /// folding it into. If so, there is no cost to include it in the addressing
   4938 /// mode. KnownLive1 and KnownLive2 are two values that we know are live at the
   4939 /// instruction already.
   4940 bool AddressingModeMatcher::valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(Value *Val,Value *KnownLive1,
   4941                                                    Value *KnownLive2) {
   4942   // If Val is either of the known-live values, we know it is live!
   4943   if (Val == nullptr || Val == KnownLive1 || Val == KnownLive2)
   4944     return true;
   4945 
   4946   // All values other than instructions and arguments (e.g. constants) are live.
   4947   if (!isa<Instruction>(Val) && !isa<Argument>(Val)) return true;
   4948 
   4949   // If Val is a constant sized alloca in the entry block, it is live, this is
   4950   // true because it is just a reference to the stack/frame pointer, which is
   4951   // live for the whole function.
   4952   if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(Val))
   4953     if (AI->isStaticAlloca())
   4954       return true;
   4955 
   4956   // Check to see if this value is already used in the memory instruction's
   4957   // block.  If so, it's already live into the block at the very least, so we
   4958   // can reasonably fold it.
   4959   return Val->isUsedInBasicBlock(MemoryInst->getParent());
   4960 }
   4961 
   4962 /// It is possible for the addressing mode of the machine to fold the specified
   4963 /// instruction into a load or store that ultimately uses it.
   4964 /// However, the specified instruction has multiple uses.
   4965 /// Given this, it may actually increase register pressure to fold it
   4966 /// into the load. For example, consider this code:
   4967 ///
   4968 ///     X = ...
   4969 ///     Y = X+1
   4970 ///     use(Y)   -> nonload/store
   4971 ///     Z = Y+1
   4972 ///     load Z
   4973 ///
   4974 /// In this case, Y has multiple uses, and can be folded into the load of Z
   4975 /// (yielding load [X+2]).  However, doing this will cause both "X" and "X+1" to
   4976 /// be live at the use(Y) line.  If we don't fold Y into load Z, we use one
   4977 /// fewer register.  Since Y can't be folded into "use(Y)" we don't increase the
   4978 /// number of computations either.
   4979 ///
   4980 /// Note that this (like most of CodeGenPrepare) is just a rough heuristic.  If
   4981 /// X was live across 'load Z' for other reasons, we actually *would* want to
   4982 /// fold the addressing mode in the Z case.  This would make Y die earlier.
   4983 bool AddressingModeMatcher::
   4984 isProfitableToFoldIntoAddressingMode(Instruction *I, ExtAddrMode &AMBefore,
   4985                                      ExtAddrMode &AMAfter) {
   4986   if (IgnoreProfitability) return true;
   4987 
   4988   // AMBefore is the addressing mode before this instruction was folded into it,
   4989   // and AMAfter is the addressing mode after the instruction was folded.  Get
   4990   // the set of registers referenced by AMAfter and subtract out those
   4991   // referenced by AMBefore: this is the set of values which folding in this
   4992   // address extends the lifetime of.
   4993   //
   4994   // Note that there are only two potential values being referenced here,
   4995   // BaseReg and ScaleReg (global addresses are always available, as are any
   4996   // folded immediates).
   4997   Value *BaseReg = AMAfter.BaseReg, *ScaledReg = AMAfter.ScaledReg;
   4998 
   4999   // If the BaseReg or ScaledReg was referenced by the previous addrmode, their
   5000   // lifetime wasn't extended by adding this instruction.
   5001   if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(BaseReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
   5002     BaseReg = nullptr;
   5003   if (valueAlreadyLiveAtInst(ScaledReg, AMBefore.BaseReg, AMBefore.ScaledReg))
   5004     ScaledReg = nullptr;
   5005 
   5006   // If folding this instruction (and it's subexprs) didn't extend any live
   5007   // ranges, we're ok with it.
   5008   if (!BaseReg && !ScaledReg)
   5009     return true;
   5010 
   5011   // If all uses of this instruction can have the address mode sunk into them,
   5012   // we can remove the addressing mode and effectively trade one live register
   5013   // for another (at worst.)  In this context, folding an addressing mode into
   5014   // the use is just a particularly nice way of sinking it.
   5015   SmallVector<std::pair<Instruction*,unsigned>, 16> MemoryUses;
   5016   SmallPtrSet<Instruction*, 16> ConsideredInsts;
   5017   if (FindAllMemoryUses(I, MemoryUses, ConsideredInsts, TLI, TRI, OptSize,
   5018                         PSI, BFI))
   5019     return false;  // Has a non-memory, non-foldable use!
   5020 
   5021   // Now that we know that all uses of this instruction are part of a chain of
   5022   // computation involving only operations that could theoretically be folded
   5023   // into a memory use, loop over each of these memory operation uses and see
   5024   // if they could  *actually* fold the instruction.  The assumption is that
   5025   // addressing modes are cheap and that duplicating the computation involved
   5026   // many times is worthwhile, even on a fastpath. For sinking candidates
   5027   // (i.e. cold call sites), this serves as a way to prevent excessive code
   5028   // growth since most architectures have some reasonable small and fast way to
   5029   // compute an effective address.  (i.e LEA on x86)
   5030   SmallVector<Instruction*, 32> MatchedAddrModeInsts;
   5031   for (unsigned i = 0, e = MemoryUses.size(); i != e; ++i) {
   5032     Instruction *User = MemoryUses[i].first;
   5033     unsigned OpNo = MemoryUses[i].second;
   5034 
   5035     // Get the access type of this use.  If the use isn't a pointer, we don't
   5036     // know what it accesses.
   5037     Value *Address = User->getOperand(OpNo);
   5038     PointerType *AddrTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Address->getType());
   5039     if (!AddrTy)
   5040       return false;
   5041     Type *AddressAccessTy = AddrTy->getElementType();
   5042     unsigned AS = AddrTy->getAddressSpace();
   5043 
   5044     // Do a match against the root of this address, ignoring profitability. This
   5045     // will tell us if the addressing mode for the memory operation will
   5046     // *actually* cover the shared instruction.
   5047     ExtAddrMode Result;
   5048     std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
   5049                                                                       0);
   5050     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   5051         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   5052     AddressingModeMatcher Matcher(MatchedAddrModeInsts, TLI, TRI, LI, getDTFn,
   5053                                   AddressAccessTy, AS, MemoryInst, Result,
   5054                                   InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT,
   5055                                   LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI, BFI);
   5056     Matcher.IgnoreProfitability = true;
   5057     bool Success = Matcher.matchAddr(Address, 0);
   5058     (void)Success; assert(Success && "Couldn't select *anything*?");
   5059 
   5060     // The match was to check the profitability, the changes made are not
   5061     // part of the original matcher. Therefore, they should be dropped
   5062     // otherwise the original matcher will not present the right state.
   5063     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   5064 
   5065     // If the match didn't cover I, then it won't be shared by it.
   5066     if (!is_contained(MatchedAddrModeInsts, I))
   5067       return false;
   5068 
   5069     MatchedAddrModeInsts.clear();
   5070   }
   5071 
   5072   return true;
   5073 }
   5074 
   5075 /// Return true if the specified values are defined in a
   5076 /// different basic block than BB.
   5077 static bool IsNonLocalValue(Value *V, BasicBlock *BB) {
   5078   if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
   5079     return I->getParent() != BB;
   5080   return false;
   5081 }
   5082 
   5083 /// Sink addressing mode computation immediate before MemoryInst if doing so
   5084 /// can be done without increasing register pressure.  The need for the
   5085 /// register pressure constraint means this can end up being an all or nothing
   5086 /// decision for all uses of the same addressing computation.
   5087 ///
   5088 /// Load and Store Instructions often have addressing modes that can do
   5089 /// significant amounts of computation. As such, instruction selection will try
   5090 /// to get the load or store to do as much computation as possible for the
   5091 /// program. The problem is that isel can only see within a single block. As
   5092 /// such, we sink as much legal addressing mode work into the block as possible.
   5093 ///
   5094 /// This method is used to optimize both load/store and inline asms with memory
   5095 /// operands.  It's also used to sink addressing computations feeding into cold
   5096 /// call sites into their (cold) basic block.
   5097 ///
   5098 /// The motivation for handling sinking into cold blocks is that doing so can
   5099 /// both enable other address mode sinking (by satisfying the register pressure
   5100 /// constraint above), and reduce register pressure globally (by removing the
   5101 /// addressing mode computation from the fast path entirely.).
   5102 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeMemoryInst(Instruction *MemoryInst, Value *Addr,
   5103                                         Type *AccessTy, unsigned AddrSpace) {
   5104   Value *Repl = Addr;
   5105 
   5106   // Try to collapse single-value PHI nodes.  This is necessary to undo
   5107   // unprofitable PRE transformations.
   5108   SmallVector<Value*, 8> worklist;
   5109   SmallPtrSet<Value*, 16> Visited;
   5110   worklist.push_back(Addr);
   5111 
   5112   // Use a worklist to iteratively look through PHI and select nodes, and
   5113   // ensure that the addressing mode obtained from the non-PHI/select roots of
   5114   // the graph are compatible.
   5115   bool PhiOrSelectSeen = false;
   5116   SmallVector<Instruction*, 16> AddrModeInsts;
   5117   const SimplifyQuery SQ(*DL, TLInfo);
   5118   AddressingModeCombiner AddrModes(SQ, Addr);
   5119   TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
   5120   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   5121       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   5122   while (!worklist.empty()) {
   5123     Value *V = worklist.back();
   5124     worklist.pop_back();
   5125 
   5126     // We allow traversing cyclic Phi nodes.
   5127     // In case of success after this loop we ensure that traversing through
   5128     // Phi nodes ends up with all cases to compute address of the form
   5129     //    BaseGV + Base + Scale * Index + Offset
   5130     // where Scale and Offset are constans and BaseGV, Base and Index
   5131     // are exactly the same Values in all cases.
   5132     // It means that BaseGV, Scale and Offset dominate our memory instruction
   5133     // and have the same value as they had in address computation represented
   5134     // as Phi. So we can safely sink address computation to memory instruction.
   5135     if (!Visited.insert(V).second)
   5136       continue;
   5137 
   5138     // For a PHI node, push all of its incoming values.
   5139     if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
   5140       append_range(worklist, P->incoming_values());
   5141       PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
   5142       continue;
   5143     }
   5144     // Similar for select.
   5145     if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
   5146       worklist.push_back(SI->getFalseValue());
   5147       worklist.push_back(SI->getTrueValue());
   5148       PhiOrSelectSeen = true;
   5149       continue;
   5150     }
   5151 
   5152     // For non-PHIs, determine the addressing mode being computed.  Note that
   5153     // the result may differ depending on what other uses our candidate
   5154     // addressing instructions might have.
   5155     AddrModeInsts.clear();
   5156     std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t> LargeOffsetGEP(nullptr,
   5157                                                                       0);
   5158     // Defer the query (and possible computation of) the dom tree to point of
   5159     // actual use.  It's expected that most address matches don't actually need
   5160     // the domtree.
   5161     auto getDTFn = [MemoryInst, this]() -> const DominatorTree & {
   5162       Function *F = MemoryInst->getParent()->getParent();
   5163       return this->getDT(*F);
   5164     };
   5165     ExtAddrMode NewAddrMode = AddressingModeMatcher::Match(
   5166         V, AccessTy, AddrSpace, MemoryInst, AddrModeInsts, *TLI, *LI, getDTFn,
   5167         *TRI, InsertedInsts, PromotedInsts, TPT, LargeOffsetGEP, OptSize, PSI,
   5168         BFI.get());
   5169 
   5170     GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP.first;
   5171     if (GEP && !NewGEPBases.count(GEP)) {
   5172       // If splitting the underlying data structure can reduce the offset of a
   5173       // GEP, collect the GEP.  Skip the GEPs that are the new bases of
   5174       // previously split data structures.
   5175       LargeOffsetGEPMap[GEP->getPointerOperand()].push_back(LargeOffsetGEP);
   5176       if (LargeOffsetGEPID.find(GEP) == LargeOffsetGEPID.end())
   5177         LargeOffsetGEPID[GEP] = LargeOffsetGEPID.size();
   5178     }
   5179 
   5180     NewAddrMode.OriginalValue = V;
   5181     if (!AddrModes.addNewAddrMode(NewAddrMode))
   5182       break;
   5183   }
   5184 
   5185   // Try to combine the AddrModes we've collected. If we couldn't collect any,
   5186   // or we have multiple but either couldn't combine them or combining them
   5187   // wouldn't do anything useful, bail out now.
   5188   if (!AddrModes.combineAddrModes()) {
   5189     TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   5190     return false;
   5191   }
   5192   bool Modified = TPT.commit();
   5193 
   5194   // Get the combined AddrMode (or the only AddrMode, if we only had one).
   5195   ExtAddrMode AddrMode = AddrModes.getAddrMode();
   5196 
   5197   // If all the instructions matched are already in this BB, don't do anything.
   5198   // If we saw a Phi node then it is not local definitely, and if we saw a select
   5199   // then we want to push the address calculation past it even if it's already
   5200   // in this BB.
   5201   if (!PhiOrSelectSeen && none_of(AddrModeInsts, [&](Value *V) {
   5202         return IsNonLocalValue(V, MemoryInst->getParent());
   5203                   })) {
   5204     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Found      local addrmode: " << AddrMode
   5205                       << "\n");
   5206     return Modified;
   5207   }
   5208 
   5209   // Insert this computation right after this user.  Since our caller is
   5210   // scanning from the top of the BB to the bottom, reuse of the expr are
   5211   // guaranteed to happen later.
   5212   IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
   5213 
   5214   // Now that we determined the addressing expression we want to use and know
   5215   // that we have to sink it into this block.  Check to see if we have already
   5216   // done this for some other load/store instr in this block.  If so, reuse
   5217   // the computation.  Before attempting reuse, check if the address is valid
   5218   // as it may have been erased.
   5219 
   5220   WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Addr];
   5221 
   5222   Value * SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
   5223   if (SunkAddr) {
   5224     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: Reusing nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
   5225                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
   5226     if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType())
   5227       SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
   5228   } else if (AddrSinkUsingGEPs || (!AddrSinkUsingGEPs.getNumOccurrences() &&
   5229                                    SubtargetInfo->addrSinkUsingGEPs())) {
   5230     // By default, we use the GEP-based method when AA is used later. This
   5231     // prevents new inttoptr/ptrtoint pairs from degrading AA capabilities.
   5232     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
   5233                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
   5234     Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
   5235     Value *ResultPtr = nullptr, *ResultIndex = nullptr;
   5236 
   5237     // First, find the pointer.
   5238     if (AddrMode.BaseReg && AddrMode.BaseReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
   5239       ResultPtr = AddrMode.BaseReg;
   5240       AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
   5241     }
   5242 
   5243     if (AddrMode.Scale && AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
   5244       // We can't add more than one pointer together, nor can we scale a
   5245       // pointer (both of which seem meaningless).
   5246       if (ResultPtr || AddrMode.Scale != 1)
   5247         return Modified;
   5248 
   5249       ResultPtr = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
   5250       AddrMode.Scale = 0;
   5251     }
   5252 
   5253     // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
   5254     // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
   5255     // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
   5256     // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
   5257     // do not match instead of extending it.
   5258     //
   5259     // (See below for code to add the scale.)
   5260     if (AddrMode.Scale) {
   5261       Type *ScaledRegTy = AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType();
   5262       if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() >
   5263           cast<IntegerType>(ScaledRegTy)->getBitWidth())
   5264         return Modified;
   5265     }
   5266 
   5267     if (AddrMode.BaseGV) {
   5268       if (ResultPtr)
   5269         return Modified;
   5270 
   5271       ResultPtr = AddrMode.BaseGV;
   5272     }
   5273 
   5274     // If the real base value actually came from an inttoptr, then the matcher
   5275     // will look through it and provide only the integer value. In that case,
   5276     // use it here.
   5277     if (!DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType())) {
   5278       if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.BaseReg) {
   5279         ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.BaseReg, Addr->getType(),
   5280                                            "sunkaddr");
   5281         AddrMode.BaseReg = nullptr;
   5282       } else if (!ResultPtr && AddrMode.Scale == 1) {
   5283         ResultPtr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(AddrMode.ScaledReg, Addr->getType(),
   5284                                            "sunkaddr");
   5285         AddrMode.Scale = 0;
   5286       }
   5287     }
   5288 
   5289     if (!ResultPtr &&
   5290         !AddrMode.BaseReg && !AddrMode.Scale && !AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
   5291       SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
   5292     } else if (!ResultPtr) {
   5293       return Modified;
   5294     } else {
   5295       Type *I8PtrTy =
   5296           Builder.getInt8PtrTy(Addr->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
   5297       Type *I8Ty = Builder.getInt8Ty();
   5298 
   5299       // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
   5300       // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
   5301       // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
   5302       // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
   5303       // we'd end up sinking both muls.
   5304       if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
   5305         Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
   5306         if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
   5307           V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
   5308 
   5309         ResultIndex = V;
   5310       }
   5311 
   5312       // Add the scale value.
   5313       if (AddrMode.Scale) {
   5314         Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
   5315         if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
   5316           // done.
   5317         } else {
   5318           assert(cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
   5319                  cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() &&
   5320                  "We can't transform if ScaledReg is too narrow");
   5321           V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
   5322         }
   5323 
   5324         if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
   5325           V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
   5326                                 "sunkaddr");
   5327         if (ResultIndex)
   5328           ResultIndex = Builder.CreateAdd(ResultIndex, V, "sunkaddr");
   5329         else
   5330           ResultIndex = V;
   5331       }
   5332 
   5333       // Add in the Base Offset if present.
   5334       if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
   5335         Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
   5336         if (ResultIndex) {
   5337           // We need to add this separately from the scale above to help with
   5338           // SDAG consecutive load/store merging.
   5339           if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
   5340             ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
   5341           ResultPtr =
   5342               AddrMode.InBounds
   5343                   ? Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(I8Ty, ResultPtr, ResultIndex,
   5344                                               "sunkaddr")
   5345                   : Builder.CreateGEP(I8Ty, ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr");
   5346         }
   5347 
   5348         ResultIndex = V;
   5349       }
   5350 
   5351       if (!ResultIndex) {
   5352         SunkAddr = ResultPtr;
   5353       } else {
   5354         if (ResultPtr->getType() != I8PtrTy)
   5355           ResultPtr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(ResultPtr, I8PtrTy);
   5356         SunkAddr =
   5357             AddrMode.InBounds
   5358                 ? Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(I8Ty, ResultPtr, ResultIndex,
   5359                                             "sunkaddr")
   5360                 : Builder.CreateGEP(I8Ty, ResultPtr, ResultIndex, "sunkaddr");
   5361       }
   5362 
   5363       if (SunkAddr->getType() != Addr->getType())
   5364         SunkAddr = Builder.CreatePointerCast(SunkAddr, Addr->getType());
   5365     }
   5366   } else {
   5367     // We'd require a ptrtoint/inttoptr down the line, which we can't do for
   5368     // non-integral pointers, so in that case bail out now.
   5369     Type *BaseTy = AddrMode.BaseReg ? AddrMode.BaseReg->getType() : nullptr;
   5370     Type *ScaleTy = AddrMode.Scale ? AddrMode.ScaledReg->getType() : nullptr;
   5371     PointerType *BasePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(BaseTy);
   5372     PointerType *ScalePtrTy = dyn_cast_or_null<PointerType>(ScaleTy);
   5373     if (DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(Addr->getType()) ||
   5374         (BasePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(BasePtrTy)) ||
   5375         (ScalePtrTy && DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(ScalePtrTy)) ||
   5376         (AddrMode.BaseGV &&
   5377          DL->isNonIntegralPointerType(AddrMode.BaseGV->getType())))
   5378       return Modified;
   5379 
   5380     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "CGP: SINKING nonlocal addrmode: " << AddrMode
   5381                       << " for " << *MemoryInst << "\n");
   5382     Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(Addr->getType());
   5383     Value *Result = nullptr;
   5384 
   5385     // Start with the base register. Do this first so that subsequent address
   5386     // matching finds it last, which will prevent it from trying to match it
   5387     // as the scaled value in case it happens to be a mul. That would be
   5388     // problematic if we've sunk a different mul for the scale, because then
   5389     // we'd end up sinking both muls.
   5390     if (AddrMode.BaseReg) {
   5391       Value *V = AddrMode.BaseReg;
   5392       if (V->getType()->isPointerTy())
   5393         V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
   5394       if (V->getType() != IntPtrTy)
   5395         V = Builder.CreateIntCast(V, IntPtrTy, /*isSigned=*/true, "sunkaddr");
   5396       Result = V;
   5397     }
   5398 
   5399     // Add the scale value.
   5400     if (AddrMode.Scale) {
   5401       Value *V = AddrMode.ScaledReg;
   5402       if (V->getType() == IntPtrTy) {
   5403         // done.
   5404       } else if (V->getType()->isPointerTy()) {
   5405         V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
   5406       } else if (cast<IntegerType>(IntPtrTy)->getBitWidth() <
   5407                  cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth()) {
   5408         V = Builder.CreateTrunc(V, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
   5409       } else {
   5410         // It is only safe to sign extend the BaseReg if we know that the math
   5411         // required to create it did not overflow before we extend it. Since
   5412         // the original IR value was tossed in favor of a constant back when
   5413         // the AddrMode was created we need to bail out gracefully if widths
   5414         // do not match instead of extending it.
   5415         Instruction *I = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(Result);
   5416         if (I && (Result != AddrMode.BaseReg))
   5417           I->eraseFromParent();
   5418         return Modified;
   5419       }
   5420       if (AddrMode.Scale != 1)
   5421         V = Builder.CreateMul(V, ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.Scale),
   5422                               "sunkaddr");
   5423       if (Result)
   5424         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
   5425       else
   5426         Result = V;
   5427     }
   5428 
   5429     // Add in the BaseGV if present.
   5430     if (AddrMode.BaseGV) {
   5431       Value *V = Builder.CreatePtrToInt(AddrMode.BaseGV, IntPtrTy, "sunkaddr");
   5432       if (Result)
   5433         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
   5434       else
   5435         Result = V;
   5436     }
   5437 
   5438     // Add in the Base Offset if present.
   5439     if (AddrMode.BaseOffs) {
   5440       Value *V = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, AddrMode.BaseOffs);
   5441       if (Result)
   5442         Result = Builder.CreateAdd(Result, V, "sunkaddr");
   5443       else
   5444         Result = V;
   5445     }
   5446 
   5447     if (!Result)
   5448       SunkAddr = Constant::getNullValue(Addr->getType());
   5449     else
   5450       SunkAddr = Builder.CreateIntToPtr(Result, Addr->getType(), "sunkaddr");
   5451   }
   5452 
   5453   MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Repl, SunkAddr);
   5454   // Store the newly computed address into the cache. In the case we reused a
   5455   // value, this should be idempotent.
   5456   SunkAddrs[Addr] = WeakTrackingVH(SunkAddr);
   5457 
   5458   // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
   5459   // using it.
   5460   if (Repl->use_empty()) {
   5461     resetIteratorIfInvalidatedWhileCalling(CurInstIterator->getParent(), [&]() {
   5462       RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
   5463           Repl, TLInfo, nullptr,
   5464           [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
   5465     });
   5466   }
   5467   ++NumMemoryInsts;
   5468   return true;
   5469 }
   5470 
   5471 /// Rewrite GEP input to gather/scatter to enable SelectionDAGBuilder to find
   5472 /// a uniform base to use for ISD::MGATHER/MSCATTER. SelectionDAGBuilder can
   5473 /// only handle a 2 operand GEP in the same basic block or a splat constant
   5474 /// vector. The 2 operands to the GEP must have a scalar pointer and a vector
   5475 /// index.
   5476 ///
   5477 /// If the existing GEP has a vector base pointer that is splat, we can look
   5478 /// through the splat to find the scalar pointer. If we can't find a scalar
   5479 /// pointer there's nothing we can do.
   5480 ///
   5481 /// If we have a GEP with more than 2 indices where the middle indices are all
   5482 /// zeroes, we can replace it with 2 GEPs where the second has 2 operands.
   5483 ///
   5484 /// If the final index isn't a vector or is a splat, we can emit a scalar GEP
   5485 /// followed by a GEP with an all zeroes vector index. This will enable
   5486 /// SelectionDAGBuilder to use the scalar GEP as the uniform base and have a
   5487 /// zero index.
   5488 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeGatherScatterInst(Instruction *MemoryInst,
   5489                                                Value *Ptr) {
   5490   Value *NewAddr;
   5491 
   5492   if (const auto *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
   5493     // Don't optimize GEPs that don't have indices.
   5494     if (!GEP->hasIndices())
   5495       return false;
   5496 
   5497     // If the GEP and the gather/scatter aren't in the same BB, don't optimize.
   5498     // FIXME: We should support this by sinking the GEP.
   5499     if (MemoryInst->getParent() != GEP->getParent())
   5500       return false;
   5501 
   5502     SmallVector<Value *, 2> Ops(GEP->operands());
   5503 
   5504     bool RewriteGEP = false;
   5505 
   5506     if (Ops[0]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
   5507       Ops[0] = getSplatValue(Ops[0]);
   5508       if (!Ops[0])
   5509         return false;
   5510       RewriteGEP = true;
   5511     }
   5512 
   5513     unsigned FinalIndex = Ops.size() - 1;
   5514 
   5515     // Ensure all but the last index is 0.
   5516     // FIXME: This isn't strictly required. All that's required is that they are
   5517     // all scalars or splats.
   5518     for (unsigned i = 1; i < FinalIndex; ++i) {
   5519       auto *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Ops[i]);
   5520       if (!C)
   5521         return false;
   5522       if (isa<VectorType>(C->getType()))
   5523         C = C->getSplatValue();
   5524       auto *CI = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(C);
   5525       if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
   5526         return false;
   5527       // Scalarize the index if needed.
   5528       Ops[i] = CI;
   5529     }
   5530 
   5531     // Try to scalarize the final index.
   5532     if (Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
   5533       if (Value *V = getSplatValue(Ops[FinalIndex])) {
   5534         auto *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V);
   5535         // Don't scalarize all zeros vector.
   5536         if (!C || !C->isZero()) {
   5537           Ops[FinalIndex] = V;
   5538           RewriteGEP = true;
   5539         }
   5540       }
   5541     }
   5542 
   5543     // If we made any changes or the we have extra operands, we need to generate
   5544     // new instructions.
   5545     if (!RewriteGEP && Ops.size() == 2)
   5546       return false;
   5547 
   5548     auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
   5549 
   5550     IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
   5551 
   5552     Type *SourceTy = GEP->getSourceElementType();
   5553     Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(Ops[0]->getType()->getScalarType());
   5554 
   5555     // If the final index isn't a vector, emit a scalar GEP containing all ops
   5556     // and a vector GEP with all zeroes final index.
   5557     if (!Ops[FinalIndex]->getType()->isVectorTy()) {
   5558       NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Ops[0],
   5559                                   makeArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
   5560       auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
   5561       NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(NewAddr, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
   5562     } else {
   5563       Value *Base = Ops[0];
   5564       Value *Index = Ops[FinalIndex];
   5565 
   5566       // Create a scalar GEP if there are more than 2 operands.
   5567       if (Ops.size() != 2) {
   5568         // Replace the last index with 0.
   5569         Ops[FinalIndex] = Constant::getNullValue(ScalarIndexTy);
   5570         Base = Builder.CreateGEP(SourceTy, Base,
   5571                                  makeArrayRef(Ops).drop_front());
   5572       }
   5573 
   5574       // Now create the GEP with scalar pointer and vector index.
   5575       NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(Base, Index);
   5576     }
   5577   } else if (!isa<Constant>(Ptr)) {
   5578     // Not a GEP, maybe its a splat and we can create a GEP to enable
   5579     // SelectionDAGBuilder to use it as a uniform base.
   5580     Value *V = getSplatValue(Ptr);
   5581     if (!V)
   5582       return false;
   5583 
   5584     auto NumElts = cast<VectorType>(Ptr->getType())->getElementCount();
   5585 
   5586     IRBuilder<> Builder(MemoryInst);
   5587 
   5588     // Emit a vector GEP with a scalar pointer and all 0s vector index.
   5589     Type *ScalarIndexTy = DL->getIndexType(V->getType()->getScalarType());
   5590     auto *IndexTy = VectorType::get(ScalarIndexTy, NumElts);
   5591     NewAddr = Builder.CreateGEP(V, Constant::getNullValue(IndexTy));
   5592   } else {
   5593     // Constant, SelectionDAGBuilder knows to check if its a splat.
   5594     return false;
   5595   }
   5596 
   5597   MemoryInst->replaceUsesOfWith(Ptr, NewAddr);
   5598 
   5599   // If we have no uses, recursively delete the value and all dead instructions
   5600   // using it.
   5601   if (Ptr->use_empty())
   5602     RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
   5603         Ptr, TLInfo, nullptr,
   5604         [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
   5605 
   5606   return true;
   5607 }
   5608 
   5609 /// If there are any memory operands, use OptimizeMemoryInst to sink their
   5610 /// address computing into the block when possible / profitable.
   5611 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInlineAsmInst(CallInst *CS) {
   5612   bool MadeChange = false;
   5613 
   5614   const TargetRegisterInfo *TRI =
   5615       TM->getSubtargetImpl(*CS->getFunction())->getRegisterInfo();
   5616   TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfoVector TargetConstraints =
   5617       TLI->ParseConstraints(*DL, TRI, *CS);
   5618   unsigned ArgNo = 0;
   5619   for (unsigned i = 0, e = TargetConstraints.size(); i != e; ++i) {
   5620     TargetLowering::AsmOperandInfo &OpInfo = TargetConstraints[i];
   5621 
   5622     // Compute the constraint code and ConstraintType to use.
   5623     TLI->ComputeConstraintToUse(OpInfo, SDValue());
   5624 
   5625     if (OpInfo.ConstraintType == TargetLowering::C_Memory &&
   5626         OpInfo.isIndirect) {
   5627       Value *OpVal = CS->getArgOperand(ArgNo++);
   5628       MadeChange |= optimizeMemoryInst(CS, OpVal, OpVal->getType(), ~0u);
   5629     } else if (OpInfo.Type == InlineAsm::isInput)
   5630       ArgNo++;
   5631   }
   5632 
   5633   return MadeChange;
   5634 }
   5635 
   5636 /// Check if all the uses of \p Val are equivalent (or free) zero or
   5637 /// sign extensions.
   5638 static bool hasSameExtUse(Value *Val, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   5639   assert(!Val->use_empty() && "Input must have at least one use");
   5640   const Instruction *FirstUser = cast<Instruction>(*Val->user_begin());
   5641   bool IsSExt = isa<SExtInst>(FirstUser);
   5642   Type *ExtTy = FirstUser->getType();
   5643   for (const User *U : Val->users()) {
   5644     const Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
   5645     if ((IsSExt && !isa<SExtInst>(UI)) || (!IsSExt && !isa<ZExtInst>(UI)))
   5646       return false;
   5647     Type *CurTy = UI->getType();
   5648     // Same input and output types: Same instruction after CSE.
   5649     if (CurTy == ExtTy)
   5650       continue;
   5651 
   5652     // If IsSExt is true, we are in this situation:
   5653     // a = Val
   5654     // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
   5655     // c = sext ty1 a to ty3
   5656     // Assuming ty2 is shorter than ty3, this could be turned into:
   5657     // a = Val
   5658     // b = sext ty1 a to ty2
   5659     // c = sext ty2 b to ty3
   5660     // However, the last sext is not free.
   5661     if (IsSExt)
   5662       return false;
   5663 
   5664     // This is a ZExt, maybe this is free to extend from one type to another.
   5665     // In that case, we would not account for a different use.
   5666     Type *NarrowTy;
   5667     Type *LargeTy;
   5668     if (ExtTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth() >
   5669         CurTy->getScalarType()->getIntegerBitWidth()) {
   5670       NarrowTy = CurTy;
   5671       LargeTy = ExtTy;
   5672     } else {
   5673       NarrowTy = ExtTy;
   5674       LargeTy = CurTy;
   5675     }
   5676 
   5677     if (!TLI.isZExtFree(NarrowTy, LargeTy))
   5678       return false;
   5679   }
   5680   // All uses are the same or can be derived from one another for free.
   5681   return true;
   5682 }
   5683 
   5684 /// Try to speculatively promote extensions in \p Exts and continue
   5685 /// promoting through newly promoted operands recursively as far as doing so is
   5686 /// profitable. Save extensions profitably moved up, in \p ProfitablyMovedExts.
   5687 /// When some promotion happened, \p TPT contains the proper state to revert
   5688 /// them.
   5689 ///
   5690 /// \return true if some promotion happened, false otherwise.
   5691 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToPromoteExts(
   5692     TypePromotionTransaction &TPT, const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &Exts,
   5693     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &ProfitablyMovedExts,
   5694     unsigned CreatedInstsCost) {
   5695   bool Promoted = false;
   5696 
   5697   // Iterate over all the extensions to try to promote them.
   5698   for (auto *I : Exts) {
   5699     // Early check if we directly have ext(load).
   5700     if (isa<LoadInst>(I->getOperand(0))) {
   5701       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
   5702       continue;
   5703     }
   5704 
   5705     // Check whether or not we want to do any promotion.  The reason we have
   5706     // this check inside the for loop is to catch the case where an extension
   5707     // is directly fed by a load because in such case the extension can be moved
   5708     // up without any promotion on its operands.
   5709     if (!TLI->enableExtLdPromotion() || DisableExtLdPromotion)
   5710       return false;
   5711 
   5712     // Get the action to perform the promotion.
   5713     TypePromotionHelper::Action TPH =
   5714         TypePromotionHelper::getAction(I, InsertedInsts, *TLI, PromotedInsts);
   5715     // Check if we can promote.
   5716     if (!TPH) {
   5717       // Save the current extension as we cannot move up through its operand.
   5718       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
   5719       continue;
   5720     }
   5721 
   5722     // Save the current state.
   5723     TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   5724         TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   5725     SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> NewExts;
   5726     unsigned NewCreatedInstsCost = 0;
   5727     unsigned ExtCost = !TLI->isExtFree(I);
   5728     // Promote.
   5729     Value *PromotedVal = TPH(I, TPT, PromotedInsts, NewCreatedInstsCost,
   5730                              &NewExts, nullptr, *TLI);
   5731     assert(PromotedVal &&
   5732            "TypePromotionHelper should have filtered out those cases");
   5733 
   5734     // We would be able to merge only one extension in a load.
   5735     // Therefore, if we have more than 1 new extension we heuristically
   5736     // cut this search path, because it means we degrade the code quality.
   5737     // With exactly 2, the transformation is neutral, because we will merge
   5738     // one extension but leave one. However, we optimistically keep going,
   5739     // because the new extension may be removed too.
   5740     long long TotalCreatedInstsCost = CreatedInstsCost + NewCreatedInstsCost;
   5741     // FIXME: It would be possible to propagate a negative value instead of
   5742     // conservatively ceiling it to 0.
   5743     TotalCreatedInstsCost =
   5744         std::max((long long)0, (TotalCreatedInstsCost - ExtCost));
   5745     if (!StressExtLdPromotion &&
   5746         (TotalCreatedInstsCost > 1 ||
   5747          !isPromotedInstructionLegal(*TLI, *DL, PromotedVal))) {
   5748       // This promotion is not profitable, rollback to the previous state, and
   5749       // save the current extension in ProfitablyMovedExts as the latest
   5750       // speculative promotion turned out to be unprofitable.
   5751       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   5752       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
   5753       continue;
   5754     }
   5755     // Continue promoting NewExts as far as doing so is profitable.
   5756     SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> NewlyMovedExts;
   5757     (void)tryToPromoteExts(TPT, NewExts, NewlyMovedExts, TotalCreatedInstsCost);
   5758     bool NewPromoted = false;
   5759     for (auto *ExtInst : NewlyMovedExts) {
   5760       Instruction *MovedExt = cast<Instruction>(ExtInst);
   5761       Value *ExtOperand = MovedExt->getOperand(0);
   5762       // If we have reached to a load, we need this extra profitability check
   5763       // as it could potentially be merged into an ext(load).
   5764       if (isa<LoadInst>(ExtOperand) &&
   5765           !(StressExtLdPromotion || NewCreatedInstsCost <= ExtCost ||
   5766             (ExtOperand->hasOneUse() || hasSameExtUse(ExtOperand, *TLI))))
   5767         continue;
   5768 
   5769       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(MovedExt);
   5770       NewPromoted = true;
   5771     }
   5772 
   5773     // If none of speculative promotions for NewExts is profitable, rollback
   5774     // and save the current extension (I) as the last profitable extension.
   5775     if (!NewPromoted) {
   5776       TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   5777       ProfitablyMovedExts.push_back(I);
   5778       continue;
   5779     }
   5780     // The promotion is profitable.
   5781     Promoted = true;
   5782   }
   5783   return Promoted;
   5784 }
   5785 
   5786 /// Merging redundant sexts when one is dominating the other.
   5787 bool CodeGenPrepare::mergeSExts(Function &F) {
   5788   bool Changed = false;
   5789   for (auto &Entry : ValToSExtendedUses) {
   5790     SExts &Insts = Entry.second;
   5791     SExts CurPts;
   5792     for (Instruction *Inst : Insts) {
   5793       if (RemovedInsts.count(Inst) || !isa<SExtInst>(Inst) ||
   5794           Inst->getOperand(0) != Entry.first)
   5795         continue;
   5796       bool inserted = false;
   5797       for (auto &Pt : CurPts) {
   5798         if (getDT(F).dominates(Inst, Pt)) {
   5799           Pt->replaceAllUsesWith(Inst);
   5800           RemovedInsts.insert(Pt);
   5801           Pt->removeFromParent();
   5802           Pt = Inst;
   5803           inserted = true;
   5804           Changed = true;
   5805           break;
   5806         }
   5807         if (!getDT(F).dominates(Pt, Inst))
   5808           // Give up if we need to merge in a common dominator as the
   5809           // experiments show it is not profitable.
   5810           continue;
   5811         Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(Pt);
   5812         RemovedInsts.insert(Inst);
   5813         Inst->removeFromParent();
   5814         inserted = true;
   5815         Changed = true;
   5816         break;
   5817       }
   5818       if (!inserted)
   5819         CurPts.push_back(Inst);
   5820     }
   5821   }
   5822   return Changed;
   5823 }
   5824 
   5825 // Splitting large data structures so that the GEPs accessing them can have
   5826 // smaller offsets so that they can be sunk to the same blocks as their users.
   5827 // For example, a large struct starting from %base is split into two parts
   5828 // where the second part starts from %new_base.
   5829 //
   5830 // Before:
   5831 // BB0:
   5832 //   %base     =
   5833 //
   5834 // BB1:
   5835 //   %gep0     = gep %base, off0
   5836 //   %gep1     = gep %base, off1
   5837 //   %gep2     = gep %base, off2
   5838 //
   5839 // BB2:
   5840 //   %load1    = load %gep0
   5841 //   %load2    = load %gep1
   5842 //   %load3    = load %gep2
   5843 //
   5844 // After:
   5845 // BB0:
   5846 //   %base     =
   5847 //   %new_base = gep %base, off0
   5848 //
   5849 // BB1:
   5850 //   %new_gep0 = %new_base
   5851 //   %new_gep1 = gep %new_base, off1 - off0
   5852 //   %new_gep2 = gep %new_base, off2 - off0
   5853 //
   5854 // BB2:
   5855 //   %load1    = load i32, i32* %new_gep0
   5856 //   %load2    = load i32, i32* %new_gep1
   5857 //   %load3    = load i32, i32* %new_gep2
   5858 //
   5859 // %new_gep1 and %new_gep2 can be sunk to BB2 now after the splitting because
   5860 // their offsets are smaller enough to fit into the addressing mode.
   5861 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitLargeGEPOffsets() {
   5862   bool Changed = false;
   5863   for (auto &Entry : LargeOffsetGEPMap) {
   5864     Value *OldBase = Entry.first;
   5865     SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<AssertingVH<GetElementPtrInst>, int64_t>>
   5866         &LargeOffsetGEPs = Entry.second;
   5867     auto compareGEPOffset =
   5868         [&](const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &LHS,
   5869             const std::pair<GetElementPtrInst *, int64_t> &RHS) {
   5870           if (LHS.first == RHS.first)
   5871             return false;
   5872           if (LHS.second != RHS.second)
   5873             return LHS.second < RHS.second;
   5874           return LargeOffsetGEPID[LHS.first] < LargeOffsetGEPID[RHS.first];
   5875         };
   5876     // Sorting all the GEPs of the same data structures based on the offsets.
   5877     llvm::sort(LargeOffsetGEPs, compareGEPOffset);
   5878     LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(
   5879         std::unique(LargeOffsetGEPs.begin(), LargeOffsetGEPs.end()),
   5880         LargeOffsetGEPs.end());
   5881     // Skip if all the GEPs have the same offsets.
   5882     if (LargeOffsetGEPs.front().second == LargeOffsetGEPs.back().second)
   5883       continue;
   5884     GetElementPtrInst *BaseGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->first;
   5885     int64_t BaseOffset = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin()->second;
   5886     Value *NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
   5887 
   5888     auto *LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.begin();
   5889     while (LargeOffsetGEP != LargeOffsetGEPs.end()) {
   5890       GetElementPtrInst *GEP = LargeOffsetGEP->first;
   5891       int64_t Offset = LargeOffsetGEP->second;
   5892       if (Offset != BaseOffset) {
   5893         TargetLowering::AddrMode AddrMode;
   5894         AddrMode.BaseOffs = Offset - BaseOffset;
   5895         // The result type of the GEP might not be the type of the memory
   5896         // access.
   5897         if (!TLI->isLegalAddressingMode(*DL, AddrMode,
   5898                                         GEP->getResultElementType(),
   5899                                         GEP->getAddressSpace())) {
   5900           // We need to create a new base if the offset to the current base is
   5901           // too large to fit into the addressing mode. So, a very large struct
   5902           // may be split into several parts.
   5903           BaseGEP = GEP;
   5904           BaseOffset = Offset;
   5905           NewBaseGEP = nullptr;
   5906         }
   5907       }
   5908 
   5909       // Generate a new GEP to replace the current one.
   5910       LLVMContext &Ctx = GEP->getContext();
   5911       Type *IntPtrTy = DL->getIntPtrType(GEP->getType());
   5912       Type *I8PtrTy =
   5913           Type::getInt8PtrTy(Ctx, GEP->getType()->getPointerAddressSpace());
   5914       Type *I8Ty = Type::getInt8Ty(Ctx);
   5915 
   5916       if (!NewBaseGEP) {
   5917         // Create a new base if we don't have one yet.  Find the insertion
   5918         // pointer for the new base first.
   5919         BasicBlock::iterator NewBaseInsertPt;
   5920         BasicBlock *NewBaseInsertBB;
   5921         if (auto *BaseI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(OldBase)) {
   5922           // If the base of the struct is an instruction, the new base will be
   5923           // inserted close to it.
   5924           NewBaseInsertBB = BaseI->getParent();
   5925           if (isa<PHINode>(BaseI))
   5926             NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   5927           else if (InvokeInst *Invoke = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(BaseI)) {
   5928             NewBaseInsertBB =
   5929                 SplitEdge(NewBaseInsertBB, Invoke->getNormalDest());
   5930             NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   5931           } else
   5932             NewBaseInsertPt = std::next(BaseI->getIterator());
   5933         } else {
   5934           // If the current base is an argument or global value, the new base
   5935           // will be inserted to the entry block.
   5936           NewBaseInsertBB = &BaseGEP->getFunction()->getEntryBlock();
   5937           NewBaseInsertPt = NewBaseInsertBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   5938         }
   5939         IRBuilder<> NewBaseBuilder(NewBaseInsertBB, NewBaseInsertPt);
   5940         // Create a new base.
   5941         Value *BaseIndex = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, BaseOffset);
   5942         NewBaseGEP = OldBase;
   5943         if (NewBaseGEP->getType() != I8PtrTy)
   5944           NewBaseGEP = NewBaseBuilder.CreatePointerCast(NewBaseGEP, I8PtrTy);
   5945         NewBaseGEP =
   5946             NewBaseBuilder.CreateGEP(I8Ty, NewBaseGEP, BaseIndex, "splitgep");
   5947         NewGEPBases.insert(NewBaseGEP);
   5948       }
   5949 
   5950       IRBuilder<> Builder(GEP);
   5951       Value *NewGEP = NewBaseGEP;
   5952       if (Offset == BaseOffset) {
   5953         if (GEP->getType() != I8PtrTy)
   5954           NewGEP = Builder.CreatePointerCast(NewGEP, GEP->getType());
   5955       } else {
   5956         // Calculate the new offset for the new GEP.
   5957         Value *Index = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Offset - BaseOffset);
   5958         NewGEP = Builder.CreateGEP(I8Ty, NewBaseGEP, Index);
   5959 
   5960         if (GEP->getType() != I8PtrTy)
   5961           NewGEP = Builder.CreatePointerCast(NewGEP, GEP->getType());
   5962       }
   5963       GEP->replaceAllUsesWith(NewGEP);
   5964       LargeOffsetGEPID.erase(GEP);
   5965       LargeOffsetGEP = LargeOffsetGEPs.erase(LargeOffsetGEP);
   5966       GEP->eraseFromParent();
   5967       Changed = true;
   5968     }
   5969   }
   5970   return Changed;
   5971 }
   5972 
   5973 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiType(
   5974     PHINode *I, SmallPtrSetImpl<PHINode *> &Visited,
   5975     SmallPtrSetImpl<Instruction *> &DeletedInstrs) {
   5976   // We are looking for a collection on interconnected phi nodes that together
   5977   // only use loads/bitcasts and are used by stores/bitcasts, and the bitcasts
   5978   // are of the same type. Convert the whole set of nodes to the type of the
   5979   // bitcast.
   5980   Type *PhiTy = I->getType();
   5981   Type *ConvertTy = nullptr;
   5982   if (Visited.count(I) ||
   5983       (!I->getType()->isIntegerTy() && !I->getType()->isFloatingPointTy()))
   5984     return false;
   5985 
   5986   SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> Worklist;
   5987   Worklist.push_back(cast<Instruction>(I));
   5988   SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> PhiNodes;
   5989   PhiNodes.insert(I);
   5990   Visited.insert(I);
   5991   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Defs;
   5992   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> Uses;
   5993   // This works by adding extra bitcasts between load/stores and removing
   5994   // existing bicasts. If we have a phi(bitcast(load)) or a store(bitcast(phi))
   5995   // we can get in the situation where we remove a bitcast in one iteration
   5996   // just to add it again in the next. We need to ensure that at least one
   5997   // bitcast we remove are anchored to something that will not change back.
   5998   bool AnyAnchored = false;
   5999 
   6000   while (!Worklist.empty()) {
   6001     Instruction *II = Worklist.pop_back_val();
   6002 
   6003     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(II)) {
   6004       // Handle Defs, which might also be PHI's
   6005       for (Value *V : Phi->incoming_values()) {
   6006         if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
   6007           if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
   6008             if (Visited.count(OpPhi))
   6009               return false;
   6010             PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
   6011             Visited.insert(OpPhi);
   6012             Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
   6013           }
   6014         } else if (auto *OpLoad = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(V)) {
   6015           if (!OpLoad->isSimple())
   6016             return false;
   6017           if (!Defs.count(OpLoad)) {
   6018             Defs.insert(OpLoad);
   6019             Worklist.push_back(OpLoad);
   6020           }
   6021         } else if (auto *OpEx = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(V)) {
   6022           if (!Defs.count(OpEx)) {
   6023             Defs.insert(OpEx);
   6024             Worklist.push_back(OpEx);
   6025           }
   6026         } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
   6027           if (!ConvertTy)
   6028             ConvertTy = OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType();
   6029           if (OpBC->getOperand(0)->getType() != ConvertTy)
   6030             return false;
   6031           if (!Defs.count(OpBC)) {
   6032             Defs.insert(OpBC);
   6033             Worklist.push_back(OpBC);
   6034             AnyAnchored |= !isa<LoadInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0)) &&
   6035                            !isa<ExtractElementInst>(OpBC->getOperand(0));
   6036           }
   6037         } else if (!isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
   6038           return false;
   6039         }
   6040       }
   6041     }
   6042 
   6043     // Handle uses which might also be phi's
   6044     for (User *V : II->users()) {
   6045       if (auto *OpPhi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(V)) {
   6046         if (!PhiNodes.count(OpPhi)) {
   6047           if (Visited.count(OpPhi))
   6048             return false;
   6049           PhiNodes.insert(OpPhi);
   6050           Visited.insert(OpPhi);
   6051           Worklist.push_back(OpPhi);
   6052         }
   6053       } else if (auto *OpStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(V)) {
   6054         if (!OpStore->isSimple() || OpStore->getOperand(0) != II)
   6055           return false;
   6056         Uses.insert(OpStore);
   6057       } else if (auto *OpBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V)) {
   6058         if (!ConvertTy)
   6059           ConvertTy = OpBC->getType();
   6060         if (OpBC->getType() != ConvertTy)
   6061           return false;
   6062         Uses.insert(OpBC);
   6063         AnyAnchored |=
   6064             any_of(OpBC->users(), [](User *U) { return !isa<StoreInst>(U); });
   6065       } else {
   6066         return false;
   6067       }
   6068     }
   6069   }
   6070 
   6071   if (!ConvertTy || !AnyAnchored || !TLI->shouldConvertPhiType(PhiTy, ConvertTy))
   6072     return false;
   6073 
   6074   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *I << "\n  and connected nodes to "
   6075                     << *ConvertTy << "\n");
   6076 
   6077   // Create all the new phi nodes of the new type, and bitcast any loads to the
   6078   // correct type.
   6079   ValueToValueMap ValMap;
   6080   ValMap[UndefValue::get(PhiTy)] = UndefValue::get(ConvertTy);
   6081   for (Instruction *D : Defs) {
   6082     if (isa<BitCastInst>(D)) {
   6083       ValMap[D] = D->getOperand(0);
   6084       DeletedInstrs.insert(D);
   6085     } else {
   6086       ValMap[D] =
   6087           new BitCastInst(D, ConvertTy, D->getName() + ".bc", D->getNextNode());
   6088     }
   6089   }
   6090   for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes)
   6091     ValMap[Phi] = PHINode::Create(ConvertTy, Phi->getNumIncomingValues(),
   6092                                   Phi->getName() + ".tc", Phi);
   6093   // Pipe together all the PhiNodes.
   6094   for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes) {
   6095     PHINode *NewPhi = cast<PHINode>(ValMap[Phi]);
   6096     for (int i = 0, e = Phi->getNumIncomingValues(); i < e; i++)
   6097       NewPhi->addIncoming(ValMap[Phi->getIncomingValue(i)],
   6098                           Phi->getIncomingBlock(i));
   6099     Visited.insert(NewPhi);
   6100   }
   6101   // And finally pipe up the stores and bitcasts
   6102   for (Instruction *U : Uses) {
   6103     if (isa<BitCastInst>(U)) {
   6104       DeletedInstrs.insert(U);
   6105       U->replaceAllUsesWith(ValMap[U->getOperand(0)]);
   6106     } else {
   6107       U->setOperand(0,
   6108                     new BitCastInst(ValMap[U->getOperand(0)], PhiTy, "bc", U));
   6109     }
   6110   }
   6111 
   6112   // Save the removed phis to be deleted later.
   6113   for (PHINode *Phi : PhiNodes)
   6114     DeletedInstrs.insert(Phi);
   6115   return true;
   6116 }
   6117 
   6118 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizePhiTypes(Function &F) {
   6119   if (!OptimizePhiTypes)
   6120     return false;
   6121 
   6122   bool Changed = false;
   6123   SmallPtrSet<PHINode *, 4> Visited;
   6124   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 4> DeletedInstrs;
   6125 
   6126   // Attempt to optimize all the phis in the functions to the correct type.
   6127   for (auto &BB : F)
   6128     for (auto &Phi : BB.phis())
   6129       Changed |= optimizePhiType(&Phi, Visited, DeletedInstrs);
   6130 
   6131   // Remove any old phi's that have been converted.
   6132   for (auto *I : DeletedInstrs) {
   6133     I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
   6134     I->eraseFromParent();
   6135   }
   6136 
   6137   return Changed;
   6138 }
   6139 
   6140 /// Return true, if an ext(load) can be formed from an extension in
   6141 /// \p MovedExts.
   6142 bool CodeGenPrepare::canFormExtLd(
   6143     const SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &MovedExts, LoadInst *&LI,
   6144     Instruction *&Inst, bool HasPromoted) {
   6145   for (auto *MovedExtInst : MovedExts) {
   6146     if (isa<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0))) {
   6147       LI = cast<LoadInst>(MovedExtInst->getOperand(0));
   6148       Inst = MovedExtInst;
   6149       break;
   6150     }
   6151   }
   6152   if (!LI)
   6153     return false;
   6154 
   6155   // If they're already in the same block, there's nothing to do.
   6156   // Make the cheap checks first if we did not promote.
   6157   // If we promoted, we need to check if it is indeed profitable.
   6158   if (!HasPromoted && LI->getParent() == Inst->getParent())
   6159     return false;
   6160 
   6161   return TLI->isExtLoad(LI, Inst, *DL);
   6162 }
   6163 
   6164 /// Move a zext or sext fed by a load into the same basic block as the load,
   6165 /// unless conditions are unfavorable. This allows SelectionDAG to fold the
   6166 /// extend into the load.
   6167 ///
   6168 /// E.g.,
   6169 /// \code
   6170 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
   6171 /// %add = add nuw i32 %ld, 4
   6172 /// %zext = zext i32 %add to i64
   6173 // \endcode
   6174 /// =>
   6175 /// \code
   6176 /// %ld = load i32* %addr
   6177 /// %zext = zext i32 %ld to i64
   6178 /// %add = add nuw i64 %zext, 4
   6179 /// \encode
   6180 /// Note that the promotion in %add to i64 is done in tryToPromoteExts(), which
   6181 /// allow us to match zext(load i32*) to i64.
   6182 ///
   6183 /// Also, try to promote the computations used to obtain a sign extended
   6184 /// value used into memory accesses.
   6185 /// E.g.,
   6186 /// \code
   6187 /// a = add nsw i32 b, 3
   6188 /// d = sext i32 a to i64
   6189 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 d
   6190 /// \endcode
   6191 /// =>
   6192 /// \code
   6193 /// f = sext i32 b to i64
   6194 /// a = add nsw i64 f, 3
   6195 /// e = getelementptr ..., i64 a
   6196 /// \endcode
   6197 ///
   6198 /// \p Inst[in/out] the extension may be modified during the process if some
   6199 /// promotions apply.
   6200 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExt(Instruction *&Inst) {
   6201   bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader = false;
   6202   /// See if it is an interesting sext operations for the address type
   6203   /// promotion before trying to promote it, e.g., the ones with the right
   6204   /// type and used in memory accesses.
   6205   bool ATPConsiderable = TTI->shouldConsiderAddressTypePromotion(
   6206       *Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader);
   6207   TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
   6208   TypePromotionTransaction::ConstRestorationPt LastKnownGood =
   6209       TPT.getRestorationPoint();
   6210   SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
   6211   SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> SpeculativelyMovedExts;
   6212   Exts.push_back(Inst);
   6213 
   6214   bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, SpeculativelyMovedExts);
   6215 
   6216   // Look for a load being extended.
   6217   LoadInst *LI = nullptr;
   6218   Instruction *ExtFedByLoad;
   6219 
   6220   // Try to promote a chain of computation if it allows to form an extended
   6221   // load.
   6222   if (canFormExtLd(SpeculativelyMovedExts, LI, ExtFedByLoad, HasPromoted)) {
   6223     assert(LI && ExtFedByLoad && "Expect a valid load and extension");
   6224     TPT.commit();
   6225     // Move the extend into the same block as the load.
   6226     ExtFedByLoad->moveAfter(LI);
   6227     ++NumExtsMoved;
   6228     Inst = ExtFedByLoad;
   6229     return true;
   6230   }
   6231 
   6232   // Continue promoting SExts if known as considerable depending on targets.
   6233   if (ATPConsiderable &&
   6234       performAddressTypePromotion(Inst, AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
   6235                                   HasPromoted, TPT, SpeculativelyMovedExts))
   6236     return true;
   6237 
   6238   TPT.rollback(LastKnownGood);
   6239   return false;
   6240 }
   6241 
   6242 // Perform address type promotion if doing so is profitable.
   6243 // If AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == false, we should find other sext
   6244 // instructions that sign extended the same initial value. However, if
   6245 // AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader == true, we expect promoting the
   6246 // extension is just profitable.
   6247 bool CodeGenPrepare::performAddressTypePromotion(
   6248     Instruction *&Inst, bool AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader,
   6249     bool HasPromoted, TypePromotionTransaction &TPT,
   6250     SmallVectorImpl<Instruction *> &SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
   6251   bool Promoted = false;
   6252   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 1> UnhandledExts;
   6253   bool AllSeenFirst = true;
   6254   for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
   6255     Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
   6256     DenseMap<Value *, Instruction *>::iterator AlreadySeen =
   6257         SeenChainsForSExt.find(HeadOfChain);
   6258     // If there is an unhandled SExt which has the same header, try to promote
   6259     // it as well.
   6260     if (AlreadySeen != SeenChainsForSExt.end()) {
   6261       if (AlreadySeen->second != nullptr)
   6262         UnhandledExts.insert(AlreadySeen->second);
   6263       AllSeenFirst = false;
   6264     }
   6265   }
   6266 
   6267   if (!AllSeenFirst || (AllowPromotionWithoutCommonHeader &&
   6268                         SpeculativelyMovedExts.size() == 1)) {
   6269     TPT.commit();
   6270     if (HasPromoted)
   6271       Promoted = true;
   6272     for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
   6273       Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
   6274       SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
   6275       ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
   6276     }
   6277     // Update Inst as promotion happen.
   6278     Inst = SpeculativelyMovedExts.pop_back_val();
   6279   } else {
   6280     // This is the first chain visited from the header, keep the current chain
   6281     // as unhandled. Defer to promote this until we encounter another SExt
   6282     // chain derived from the same header.
   6283     for (auto *I : SpeculativelyMovedExts) {
   6284       Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
   6285       SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = Inst;
   6286     }
   6287     return false;
   6288   }
   6289 
   6290   if (!AllSeenFirst && !UnhandledExts.empty())
   6291     for (auto *VisitedSExt : UnhandledExts) {
   6292       if (RemovedInsts.count(VisitedSExt))
   6293         continue;
   6294       TypePromotionTransaction TPT(RemovedInsts);
   6295       SmallVector<Instruction *, 1> Exts;
   6296       SmallVector<Instruction *, 2> Chains;
   6297       Exts.push_back(VisitedSExt);
   6298       bool HasPromoted = tryToPromoteExts(TPT, Exts, Chains);
   6299       TPT.commit();
   6300       if (HasPromoted)
   6301         Promoted = true;
   6302       for (auto *I : Chains) {
   6303         Value *HeadOfChain = I->getOperand(0);
   6304         // Mark this as handled.
   6305         SeenChainsForSExt[HeadOfChain] = nullptr;
   6306         ValToSExtendedUses[HeadOfChain].push_back(I);
   6307       }
   6308     }
   6309   return Promoted;
   6310 }
   6311 
   6312 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtUses(Instruction *I) {
   6313   BasicBlock *DefBB = I->getParent();
   6314 
   6315   // If the result of a {s|z}ext and its source are both live out, rewrite all
   6316   // other uses of the source with result of extension.
   6317   Value *Src = I->getOperand(0);
   6318   if (Src->hasOneUse())
   6319     return false;
   6320 
   6321   // Only do this xform if truncating is free.
   6322   if (!TLI->isTruncateFree(I->getType(), Src->getType()))
   6323     return false;
   6324 
   6325   // Only safe to perform the optimization if the source is also defined in
   6326   // this block.
   6327   if (!isa<Instruction>(Src) || DefBB != cast<Instruction>(Src)->getParent())
   6328     return false;
   6329 
   6330   bool DefIsLiveOut = false;
   6331   for (User *U : I->users()) {
   6332     Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
   6333 
   6334     // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
   6335     BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
   6336     if (UserBB == DefBB) continue;
   6337     DefIsLiveOut = true;
   6338     break;
   6339   }
   6340   if (!DefIsLiveOut)
   6341     return false;
   6342 
   6343   // Make sure none of the uses are PHI nodes.
   6344   for (User *U : Src->users()) {
   6345     Instruction *UI = cast<Instruction>(U);
   6346     BasicBlock *UserBB = UI->getParent();
   6347     if (UserBB == DefBB) continue;
   6348     // Be conservative. We don't want this xform to end up introducing
   6349     // reloads just before load / store instructions.
   6350     if (isa<PHINode>(UI) || isa<LoadInst>(UI) || isa<StoreInst>(UI))
   6351       return false;
   6352   }
   6353 
   6354   // InsertedTruncs - Only insert one trunc in each block once.
   6355   DenseMap<BasicBlock*, Instruction*> InsertedTruncs;
   6356 
   6357   bool MadeChange = false;
   6358   for (Use &U : Src->uses()) {
   6359     Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(U.getUser());
   6360 
   6361     // Figure out which BB this ext is used in.
   6362     BasicBlock *UserBB = User->getParent();
   6363     if (UserBB == DefBB) continue;
   6364 
   6365     // Both src and def are live in this block. Rewrite the use.
   6366     Instruction *&InsertedTrunc = InsertedTruncs[UserBB];
   6367 
   6368     if (!InsertedTrunc) {
   6369       BasicBlock::iterator InsertPt = UserBB->getFirstInsertionPt();
   6370       assert(InsertPt != UserBB->end());
   6371       InsertedTrunc = new TruncInst(I, Src->getType(), "", &*InsertPt);
   6372       InsertedInsts.insert(InsertedTrunc);
   6373     }
   6374 
   6375     // Replace a use of the {s|z}ext source with a use of the result.
   6376     U = InsertedTrunc;
   6377     ++NumExtUses;
   6378     MadeChange = true;
   6379   }
   6380 
   6381   return MadeChange;
   6382 }
   6383 
   6384 // Find loads whose uses only use some of the loaded value's bits.  Add an "and"
   6385 // just after the load if the target can fold this into one extload instruction,
   6386 // with the hope of eliminating some of the other later "and" instructions using
   6387 // the loaded value.  "and"s that are made trivially redundant by the insertion
   6388 // of the new "and" are removed by this function, while others (e.g. those whose
   6389 // path from the load goes through a phi) are left for isel to potentially
   6390 // remove.
   6391 //
   6392 // For example:
   6393 //
   6394 // b0:
   6395 //   x = load i32
   6396 //   ...
   6397 // b1:
   6398 //   y = and x, 0xff
   6399 //   z = use y
   6400 //
   6401 // becomes:
   6402 //
   6403 // b0:
   6404 //   x = load i32
   6405 //   x' = and x, 0xff
   6406 //   ...
   6407 // b1:
   6408 //   z = use x'
   6409 //
   6410 // whereas:
   6411 //
   6412 // b0:
   6413 //   x1 = load i32
   6414 //   ...
   6415 // b1:
   6416 //   x2 = load i32
   6417 //   ...
   6418 // b2:
   6419 //   x = phi x1, x2
   6420 //   y = and x, 0xff
   6421 //
   6422 // becomes (after a call to optimizeLoadExt for each load):
   6423 //
   6424 // b0:
   6425 //   x1 = load i32
   6426 //   x1' = and x1, 0xff
   6427 //   ...
   6428 // b1:
   6429 //   x2 = load i32
   6430 //   x2' = and x2, 0xff
   6431 //   ...
   6432 // b2:
   6433 //   x = phi x1', x2'
   6434 //   y = and x, 0xff
   6435 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeLoadExt(LoadInst *Load) {
   6436   if (!Load->isSimple() || !Load->getType()->isIntOrPtrTy())
   6437     return false;
   6438 
   6439   // Skip loads we've already transformed.
   6440   if (Load->hasOneUse() &&
   6441       InsertedInsts.count(cast<Instruction>(*Load->user_begin())))
   6442     return false;
   6443 
   6444   // Look at all uses of Load, looking through phis, to determine how many bits
   6445   // of the loaded value are needed.
   6446   SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> WorkList;
   6447   SmallPtrSet<Instruction *, 16> Visited;
   6448   SmallVector<Instruction *, 8> AndsToMaybeRemove;
   6449   for (auto *U : Load->users())
   6450     WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
   6451 
   6452   EVT LoadResultVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, Load->getType());
   6453   unsigned BitWidth = LoadResultVT.getSizeInBits();
   6454   APInt DemandBits(BitWidth, 0);
   6455   APInt WidestAndBits(BitWidth, 0);
   6456 
   6457   while (!WorkList.empty()) {
   6458     Instruction *I = WorkList.back();
   6459     WorkList.pop_back();
   6460 
   6461     // Break use-def graph loops.
   6462     if (!Visited.insert(I).second)
   6463       continue;
   6464 
   6465     // For a PHI node, push all of its users.
   6466     if (auto *Phi = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
   6467       for (auto *U : Phi->users())
   6468         WorkList.push_back(cast<Instruction>(U));
   6469       continue;
   6470     }
   6471 
   6472     switch (I->getOpcode()) {
   6473     case Instruction::And: {
   6474       auto *AndC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
   6475       if (!AndC)
   6476         return false;
   6477       APInt AndBits = AndC->getValue();
   6478       DemandBits |= AndBits;
   6479       // Keep track of the widest and mask we see.
   6480       if (AndBits.ugt(WidestAndBits))
   6481         WidestAndBits = AndBits;
   6482       if (AndBits == WidestAndBits && I->getOperand(0) == Load)
   6483         AndsToMaybeRemove.push_back(I);
   6484       break;
   6485     }
   6486 
   6487     case Instruction::Shl: {
   6488       auto *ShlC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1));
   6489       if (!ShlC)
   6490         return false;
   6491       uint64_t ShiftAmt = ShlC->getLimitedValue(BitWidth - 1);
   6492       DemandBits.setLowBits(BitWidth - ShiftAmt);
   6493       break;
   6494     }
   6495 
   6496     case Instruction::Trunc: {
   6497       EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, I->getType());
   6498       unsigned TruncBitWidth = TruncVT.getSizeInBits();
   6499       DemandBits.setLowBits(TruncBitWidth);
   6500       break;
   6501     }
   6502 
   6503     default:
   6504       return false;
   6505     }
   6506   }
   6507 
   6508   uint32_t ActiveBits = DemandBits.getActiveBits();
   6509   // Avoid hoisting (and (load x) 1) since it is unlikely to be folded by the
   6510   // target even if isLoadExtLegal says an i1 EXTLOAD is valid.  For example,
   6511   // for the AArch64 target isLoadExtLegal(ZEXTLOAD, i32, i1) returns true, but
   6512   // (and (load x) 1) is not matched as a single instruction, rather as a LDR
   6513   // followed by an AND.
   6514   // TODO: Look into removing this restriction by fixing backends to either
   6515   // return false for isLoadExtLegal for i1 or have them select this pattern to
   6516   // a single instruction.
   6517   //
   6518   // Also avoid hoisting if we didn't see any ands with the exact DemandBits
   6519   // mask, since these are the only ands that will be removed by isel.
   6520   if (ActiveBits <= 1 || !DemandBits.isMask(ActiveBits) ||
   6521       WidestAndBits != DemandBits)
   6522     return false;
   6523 
   6524   LLVMContext &Ctx = Load->getType()->getContext();
   6525   Type *TruncTy = Type::getIntNTy(Ctx, ActiveBits);
   6526   EVT TruncVT = TLI->getValueType(*DL, TruncTy);
   6527 
   6528   // Reject cases that won't be matched as extloads.
   6529   if (!LoadResultVT.bitsGT(TruncVT) || !TruncVT.isRound() ||
   6530       !TLI->isLoadExtLegal(ISD::ZEXTLOAD, LoadResultVT, TruncVT))
   6531     return false;
   6532 
   6533   IRBuilder<> Builder(Load->getNextNode());
   6534   auto *NewAnd = cast<Instruction>(
   6535       Builder.CreateAnd(Load, ConstantInt::get(Ctx, DemandBits)));
   6536   // Mark this instruction as "inserted by CGP", so that other
   6537   // optimizations don't touch it.
   6538   InsertedInsts.insert(NewAnd);
   6539 
   6540   // Replace all uses of load with new and (except for the use of load in the
   6541   // new and itself).
   6542   Load->replaceAllUsesWith(NewAnd);
   6543   NewAnd->setOperand(0, Load);
   6544 
   6545   // Remove any and instructions that are now redundant.
   6546   for (auto *And : AndsToMaybeRemove)
   6547     // Check that the and mask is the same as the one we decided to put on the
   6548     // new and.
   6549     if (cast<ConstantInt>(And->getOperand(1))->getValue() == DemandBits) {
   6550       And->replaceAllUsesWith(NewAnd);
   6551       if (&*CurInstIterator == And)
   6552         CurInstIterator = std::next(And->getIterator());
   6553       And->eraseFromParent();
   6554       ++NumAndUses;
   6555     }
   6556 
   6557   ++NumAndsAdded;
   6558   return true;
   6559 }
   6560 
   6561 /// Check if V (an operand of a select instruction) is an expensive instruction
   6562 /// that is only used once.
   6563 static bool sinkSelectOperand(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI, Value *V) {
   6564   auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
   6565   // If it's safe to speculatively execute, then it should not have side
   6566   // effects; therefore, it's safe to sink and possibly *not* execute.
   6567   return I && I->hasOneUse() && isSafeToSpeculativelyExecute(I) &&
   6568          TTI->getUserCost(I, TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency) >=
   6569          TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Expensive;
   6570 }
   6571 
   6572 /// Returns true if a SelectInst should be turned into an explicit branch.
   6573 static bool isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(const TargetTransformInfo *TTI,
   6574                                                 const TargetLowering *TLI,
   6575                                                 SelectInst *SI) {
   6576   // If even a predictable select is cheap, then a branch can't be cheaper.
   6577   if (!TLI->isPredictableSelectExpensive())
   6578     return false;
   6579 
   6580   // FIXME: This should use the same heuristics as IfConversion to determine
   6581   // whether a select is better represented as a branch.
   6582 
   6583   // If metadata tells us that the select condition is obviously predictable,
   6584   // then we want to replace the select with a branch.
   6585   uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
   6586   if (SI->extractProfMetadata(TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
   6587     uint64_t Max = std::max(TrueWeight, FalseWeight);
   6588     uint64_t Sum = TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
   6589     if (Sum != 0) {
   6590       auto Probability = BranchProbability::getBranchProbability(Max, Sum);
   6591       if (Probability > TTI->getPredictableBranchThreshold())
   6592         return true;
   6593     }
   6594   }
   6595 
   6596   CmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
   6597 
   6598   // If a branch is predictable, an out-of-order CPU can avoid blocking on its
   6599   // comparison condition. If the compare has more than one use, there's
   6600   // probably another cmov or setcc around, so it's not worth emitting a branch.
   6601   if (!Cmp || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
   6602     return false;
   6603 
   6604   // If either operand of the select is expensive and only needed on one side
   6605   // of the select, we should form a branch.
   6606   if (sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getTrueValue()) ||
   6607       sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getFalseValue()))
   6608     return true;
   6609 
   6610   return false;
   6611 }
   6612 
   6613 /// If \p isTrue is true, return the true value of \p SI, otherwise return
   6614 /// false value of \p SI. If the true/false value of \p SI is defined by any
   6615 /// select instructions in \p Selects, look through the defining select
   6616 /// instruction until the true/false value is not defined in \p Selects.
   6617 static Value *getTrueOrFalseValue(
   6618     SelectInst *SI, bool isTrue,
   6619     const SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> &Selects) {
   6620   Value *V = nullptr;
   6621 
   6622   for (SelectInst *DefSI = SI; DefSI != nullptr && Selects.count(DefSI);
   6623        DefSI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V)) {
   6624     assert(DefSI->getCondition() == SI->getCondition() &&
   6625            "The condition of DefSI does not match with SI");
   6626     V = (isTrue ? DefSI->getTrueValue() : DefSI->getFalseValue());
   6627   }
   6628 
   6629   assert(V && "Failed to get select true/false value");
   6630   return V;
   6631 }
   6632 
   6633 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShiftInst(BinaryOperator *Shift) {
   6634   assert(Shift->isShift() && "Expected a shift");
   6635 
   6636   // If this is (1) a vector shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper than
   6637   // general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is a select-of-splatted
   6638   // values, hoist the shifts before the select:
   6639   //   shift Op0, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
   6640   //   select Cond, (shift Op0, TVal), (shift Op0, FVal)
   6641   //
   6642   // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
   6643   // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
   6644   // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
   6645   // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
   6646   Type *Ty = Shift->getType();
   6647   if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TLI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
   6648     return false;
   6649   Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
   6650   if (!match(Shift->getOperand(1),
   6651              m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
   6652     return false;
   6653   if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
   6654     return false;
   6655 
   6656   IRBuilder<> Builder(Shift);
   6657   BinaryOperator::BinaryOps Opcode = Shift->getOpcode();
   6658   Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), TVal);
   6659   Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateBinOp(Opcode, Shift->getOperand(0), FVal);
   6660   Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
   6661   Shift->replaceAllUsesWith(NewSel);
   6662   Shift->eraseFromParent();
   6663   return true;
   6664 }
   6665 
   6666 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeFunnelShift(IntrinsicInst *Fsh) {
   6667   Intrinsic::ID Opcode = Fsh->getIntrinsicID();
   6668   assert((Opcode == Intrinsic::fshl || Opcode == Intrinsic::fshr) &&
   6669          "Expected a funnel shift");
   6670 
   6671   // If this is (1) a vector funnel shift, (2) shifts by scalars are cheaper
   6672   // than general vector shifts, and (3) the shift amount is select-of-splatted
   6673   // values, hoist the funnel shifts before the select:
   6674   //   fsh Op0, Op1, (select Cond, TVal, FVal) -->
   6675   //   select Cond, (fsh Op0, Op1, TVal), (fsh Op0, Op1, FVal)
   6676   //
   6677   // This is inverting a generic IR transform when we know that the cost of a
   6678   // general vector shift is more than the cost of 2 shift-by-scalars.
   6679   // We can't do this effectively in SDAG because we may not be able to
   6680   // determine if the select operands are splats from within a basic block.
   6681   Type *Ty = Fsh->getType();
   6682   if (!Ty->isVectorTy() || !TLI->isVectorShiftByScalarCheap(Ty))
   6683     return false;
   6684   Value *Cond, *TVal, *FVal;
   6685   if (!match(Fsh->getOperand(2),
   6686              m_OneUse(m_Select(m_Value(Cond), m_Value(TVal), m_Value(FVal)))))
   6687     return false;
   6688   if (!isSplatValue(TVal) || !isSplatValue(FVal))
   6689     return false;
   6690 
   6691   IRBuilder<> Builder(Fsh);
   6692   Value *X = Fsh->getOperand(0), *Y = Fsh->getOperand(1);
   6693   Value *NewTVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, { X, Y, TVal });
   6694   Value *NewFVal = Builder.CreateIntrinsic(Opcode, Ty, { X, Y, FVal });
   6695   Value *NewSel = Builder.CreateSelect(Cond, NewTVal, NewFVal);
   6696   Fsh->replaceAllUsesWith(NewSel);
   6697   Fsh->eraseFromParent();
   6698   return true;
   6699 }
   6700 
   6701 /// If we have a SelectInst that will likely profit from branch prediction,
   6702 /// turn it into a branch.
   6703 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSelectInst(SelectInst *SI) {
   6704   if (DisableSelectToBranch)
   6705     return false;
   6706 
   6707   // Find all consecutive select instructions that share the same condition.
   6708   SmallVector<SelectInst *, 2> ASI;
   6709   ASI.push_back(SI);
   6710   for (BasicBlock::iterator It = ++BasicBlock::iterator(SI);
   6711        It != SI->getParent()->end(); ++It) {
   6712     SelectInst *I = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&*It);
   6713     if (I && SI->getCondition() == I->getCondition()) {
   6714       ASI.push_back(I);
   6715     } else {
   6716       break;
   6717     }
   6718   }
   6719 
   6720   SelectInst *LastSI = ASI.back();
   6721   // Increment the current iterator to skip all the rest of select instructions
   6722   // because they will be either "not lowered" or "all lowered" to branch.
   6723   CurInstIterator = std::next(LastSI->getIterator());
   6724 
   6725   bool VectorCond = !SI->getCondition()->getType()->isIntegerTy(1);
   6726 
   6727   // Can we convert the 'select' to CF ?
   6728   if (VectorCond || SI->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
   6729     return false;
   6730 
   6731   TargetLowering::SelectSupportKind SelectKind;
   6732   if (VectorCond)
   6733     SelectKind = TargetLowering::VectorMaskSelect;
   6734   else if (SI->getType()->isVectorTy())
   6735     SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarCondVectorVal;
   6736   else
   6737     SelectKind = TargetLowering::ScalarValSelect;
   6738 
   6739   if (TLI->isSelectSupported(SelectKind) &&
   6740       (!isFormingBranchFromSelectProfitable(TTI, TLI, SI) || OptSize ||
   6741        llvm::shouldOptimizeForSize(SI->getParent(), PSI, BFI.get())))
   6742     return false;
   6743 
   6744   // The DominatorTree needs to be rebuilt by any consumers after this
   6745   // transformation. We simply reset here rather than setting the ModifiedDT
   6746   // flag to avoid restarting the function walk in runOnFunction for each
   6747   // select optimized.
   6748   DT.reset();
   6749 
   6750   // Transform a sequence like this:
   6751   //    start:
   6752   //       %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
   6753   //       %sel = select i1 %cmp, i32 %c, i32 %d
   6754   //
   6755   // Into:
   6756   //    start:
   6757   //       %cmp = cmp uge i32 %a, %b
   6758   //       %cmp.frozen = freeze %cmp
   6759   //       br i1 %cmp.frozen, label %select.true, label %select.false
   6760   //    select.true:
   6761   //       br label %select.end
   6762   //    select.false:
   6763   //       br label %select.end
   6764   //    select.end:
   6765   //       %sel = phi i32 [ %c, %select.true ], [ %d, %select.false ]
   6766   //
   6767   // %cmp should be frozen, otherwise it may introduce undefined behavior.
   6768   // In addition, we may sink instructions that produce %c or %d from
   6769   // the entry block into the destination(s) of the new branch.
   6770   // If the true or false blocks do not contain a sunken instruction, that
   6771   // block and its branch may be optimized away. In that case, one side of the
   6772   // first branch will point directly to select.end, and the corresponding PHI
   6773   // predecessor block will be the start block.
   6774 
   6775   // First, we split the block containing the select into 2 blocks.
   6776   BasicBlock *StartBlock = SI->getParent();
   6777   BasicBlock::iterator SplitPt = ++(BasicBlock::iterator(LastSI));
   6778   BasicBlock *EndBlock = StartBlock->splitBasicBlock(SplitPt, "select.end");
   6779   BFI->setBlockFreq(EndBlock, BFI->getBlockFreq(StartBlock).getFrequency());
   6780 
   6781   // Delete the unconditional branch that was just created by the split.
   6782   StartBlock->getTerminator()->eraseFromParent();
   6783 
   6784   // These are the new basic blocks for the conditional branch.
   6785   // At least one will become an actual new basic block.
   6786   BasicBlock *TrueBlock = nullptr;
   6787   BasicBlock *FalseBlock = nullptr;
   6788   BranchInst *TrueBranch = nullptr;
   6789   BranchInst *FalseBranch = nullptr;
   6790 
   6791   // Sink expensive instructions into the conditional blocks to avoid executing
   6792   // them speculatively.
   6793   for (SelectInst *SI : ASI) {
   6794     if (sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getTrueValue())) {
   6795       if (TrueBlock == nullptr) {
   6796         TrueBlock = BasicBlock::Create(SI->getContext(), "select.true.sink",
   6797                                        EndBlock->getParent(), EndBlock);
   6798         TrueBranch = BranchInst::Create(EndBlock, TrueBlock);
   6799         TrueBranch->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
   6800       }
   6801       auto *TrueInst = cast<Instruction>(SI->getTrueValue());
   6802       TrueInst->moveBefore(TrueBranch);
   6803     }
   6804     if (sinkSelectOperand(TTI, SI->getFalseValue())) {
   6805       if (FalseBlock == nullptr) {
   6806         FalseBlock = BasicBlock::Create(SI->getContext(), "select.false.sink",
   6807                                         EndBlock->getParent(), EndBlock);
   6808         FalseBranch = BranchInst::Create(EndBlock, FalseBlock);
   6809         FalseBranch->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
   6810       }
   6811       auto *FalseInst = cast<Instruction>(SI->getFalseValue());
   6812       FalseInst->moveBefore(FalseBranch);
   6813     }
   6814   }
   6815 
   6816   // If there was nothing to sink, then arbitrarily choose the 'false' side
   6817   // for a new input value to the PHI.
   6818   if (TrueBlock == FalseBlock) {
   6819     assert(TrueBlock == nullptr &&
   6820            "Unexpected basic block transform while optimizing select");
   6821 
   6822     FalseBlock = BasicBlock::Create(SI->getContext(), "select.false",
   6823                                     EndBlock->getParent(), EndBlock);
   6824     auto *FalseBranch = BranchInst::Create(EndBlock, FalseBlock);
   6825     FalseBranch->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
   6826   }
   6827 
   6828   // Insert the real conditional branch based on the original condition.
   6829   // If we did not create a new block for one of the 'true' or 'false' paths
   6830   // of the condition, it means that side of the branch goes to the end block
   6831   // directly and the path originates from the start block from the point of
   6832   // view of the new PHI.
   6833   BasicBlock *TT, *FT;
   6834   if (TrueBlock == nullptr) {
   6835     TT = EndBlock;
   6836     FT = FalseBlock;
   6837     TrueBlock = StartBlock;
   6838   } else if (FalseBlock == nullptr) {
   6839     TT = TrueBlock;
   6840     FT = EndBlock;
   6841     FalseBlock = StartBlock;
   6842   } else {
   6843     TT = TrueBlock;
   6844     FT = FalseBlock;
   6845   }
   6846   IRBuilder<> IB(SI);
   6847   auto *CondFr = IB.CreateFreeze(SI->getCondition(), SI->getName() + ".frozen");
   6848   IB.CreateCondBr(CondFr, TT, FT, SI);
   6849 
   6850   SmallPtrSet<const Instruction *, 2> INS;
   6851   INS.insert(ASI.begin(), ASI.end());
   6852   // Use reverse iterator because later select may use the value of the
   6853   // earlier select, and we need to propagate value through earlier select
   6854   // to get the PHI operand.
   6855   for (auto It = ASI.rbegin(); It != ASI.rend(); ++It) {
   6856     SelectInst *SI = *It;
   6857     // The select itself is replaced with a PHI Node.
   6858     PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(SI->getType(), 2, "", &EndBlock->front());
   6859     PN->takeName(SI);
   6860     PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, true, INS), TrueBlock);
   6861     PN->addIncoming(getTrueOrFalseValue(SI, false, INS), FalseBlock);
   6862     PN->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
   6863 
   6864     SI->replaceAllUsesWith(PN);
   6865     SI->eraseFromParent();
   6866     INS.erase(SI);
   6867     ++NumSelectsExpanded;
   6868   }
   6869 
   6870   // Instruct OptimizeBlock to skip to the next block.
   6871   CurInstIterator = StartBlock->end();
   6872   return true;
   6873 }
   6874 
   6875 /// Some targets only accept certain types for splat inputs. For example a VDUP
   6876 /// in MVE takes a GPR (integer) register, and the instruction that incorporate
   6877 /// a VDUP (such as a VADD qd, qm, rm) also require a gpr register.
   6878 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
   6879   // Accept shuf(insertelem(undef/poison, val, 0), undef/poison, <0,0,..>) only
   6880   if (!match(SVI, m_Shuffle(m_InsertElt(m_Undef(), m_Value(), m_ZeroInt()),
   6881                             m_Undef(), m_ZeroMask())))
   6882     return false;
   6883   Type *NewType = TLI->shouldConvertSplatType(SVI);
   6884   if (!NewType)
   6885     return false;
   6886 
   6887   auto *SVIVecType = cast<FixedVectorType>(SVI->getType());
   6888   assert(!NewType->isVectorTy() && "Expected a scalar type!");
   6889   assert(NewType->getScalarSizeInBits() == SVIVecType->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
   6890          "Expected a type of the same size!");
   6891   auto *NewVecType =
   6892       FixedVectorType::get(NewType, SVIVecType->getNumElements());
   6893 
   6894   // Create a bitcast (shuffle (insert (bitcast(..))))
   6895   IRBuilder<> Builder(SVI->getContext());
   6896   Builder.SetInsertPoint(SVI);
   6897   Value *BC1 = Builder.CreateBitCast(
   6898       cast<Instruction>(SVI->getOperand(0))->getOperand(1), NewType);
   6899   Value *Shuffle = Builder.CreateVectorSplat(NewVecType->getNumElements(), BC1);
   6900   Value *BC2 = Builder.CreateBitCast(Shuffle, SVIVecType);
   6901 
   6902   SVI->replaceAllUsesWith(BC2);
   6903   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
   6904       SVI, TLInfo, nullptr, [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
   6905 
   6906   // Also hoist the bitcast up to its operand if it they are not in the same
   6907   // block.
   6908   if (auto *BCI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BC1))
   6909     if (auto *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(BCI->getOperand(0)))
   6910       if (BCI->getParent() != Op->getParent() && !isa<PHINode>(Op) &&
   6911           !Op->isTerminator() && !Op->isEHPad())
   6912         BCI->moveAfter(Op);
   6913 
   6914   return true;
   6915 }
   6916 
   6917 bool CodeGenPrepare::tryToSinkFreeOperands(Instruction *I) {
   6918   // If the operands of I can be folded into a target instruction together with
   6919   // I, duplicate and sink them.
   6920   SmallVector<Use *, 4> OpsToSink;
   6921   if (!TLI->shouldSinkOperands(I, OpsToSink))
   6922     return false;
   6923 
   6924   // OpsToSink can contain multiple uses in a use chain (e.g.
   6925   // (%u1 with %u1 = shufflevector), (%u2 with %u2 = zext %u1)). The dominating
   6926   // uses must come first, so we process the ops in reverse order so as to not
   6927   // create invalid IR.
   6928   BasicBlock *TargetBB = I->getParent();
   6929   bool Changed = false;
   6930   SmallVector<Use *, 4> ToReplace;
   6931   for (Use *U : reverse(OpsToSink)) {
   6932     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
   6933     if (UI->getParent() == TargetBB || isa<PHINode>(UI))
   6934       continue;
   6935     ToReplace.push_back(U);
   6936   }
   6937 
   6938   SetVector<Instruction *> MaybeDead;
   6939   DenseMap<Instruction *, Instruction *> NewInstructions;
   6940   Instruction *InsertPoint = I;
   6941   for (Use *U : ToReplace) {
   6942     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(U->get());
   6943     Instruction *NI = UI->clone();
   6944     NewInstructions[UI] = NI;
   6945     MaybeDead.insert(UI);
   6946     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Sinking " << *UI << " to user " << *I << "\n");
   6947     NI->insertBefore(InsertPoint);
   6948     InsertPoint = NI;
   6949     InsertedInsts.insert(NI);
   6950 
   6951     // Update the use for the new instruction, making sure that we update the
   6952     // sunk instruction uses, if it is part of a chain that has already been
   6953     // sunk.
   6954     Instruction *OldI = cast<Instruction>(U->getUser());
   6955     if (NewInstructions.count(OldI))
   6956       NewInstructions[OldI]->setOperand(U->getOperandNo(), NI);
   6957     else
   6958       U->set(NI);
   6959     Changed = true;
   6960   }
   6961 
   6962   // Remove instructions that are dead after sinking.
   6963   for (auto *I : MaybeDead) {
   6964     if (!I->hasNUsesOrMore(1)) {
   6965       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Removing dead instruction: " << *I << "\n");
   6966       I->eraseFromParent();
   6967     }
   6968   }
   6969 
   6970   return Changed;
   6971 }
   6972 
   6973 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeSwitchInst(SwitchInst *SI) {
   6974   Value *Cond = SI->getCondition();
   6975   Type *OldType = Cond->getType();
   6976   LLVMContext &Context = Cond->getContext();
   6977   MVT RegType = TLI->getRegisterType(Context, TLI->getValueType(*DL, OldType));
   6978   unsigned RegWidth = RegType.getSizeInBits();
   6979 
   6980   if (RegWidth <= cast<IntegerType>(OldType)->getBitWidth())
   6981     return false;
   6982 
   6983   // If the register width is greater than the type width, expand the condition
   6984   // of the switch instruction and each case constant to the width of the
   6985   // register. By widening the type of the switch condition, subsequent
   6986   // comparisons (for case comparisons) will not need to be extended to the
   6987   // preferred register width, so we will potentially eliminate N-1 extends,
   6988   // where N is the number of cases in the switch.
   6989   auto *NewType = Type::getIntNTy(Context, RegWidth);
   6990 
   6991   // Zero-extend the switch condition and case constants unless the switch
   6992   // condition is a function argument that is already being sign-extended.
   6993   // In that case, we can avoid an unnecessary mask/extension by sign-extending
   6994   // everything instead.
   6995   Instruction::CastOps ExtType = Instruction::ZExt;
   6996   if (auto *Arg = dyn_cast<Argument>(Cond))
   6997     if (Arg->hasSExtAttr())
   6998       ExtType = Instruction::SExt;
   6999 
   7000   auto *ExtInst = CastInst::Create(ExtType, Cond, NewType);
   7001   ExtInst->insertBefore(SI);
   7002   ExtInst->setDebugLoc(SI->getDebugLoc());
   7003   SI->setCondition(ExtInst);
   7004   for (auto Case : SI->cases()) {
   7005     APInt NarrowConst = Case.getCaseValue()->getValue();
   7006     APInt WideConst = (ExtType == Instruction::ZExt) ?
   7007                       NarrowConst.zext(RegWidth) : NarrowConst.sext(RegWidth);
   7008     Case.setValue(ConstantInt::get(Context, WideConst));
   7009   }
   7010 
   7011   return true;
   7012 }
   7013 
   7014 
   7015 namespace {
   7016 
   7017 /// Helper class to promote a scalar operation to a vector one.
   7018 /// This class is used to move downward extractelement transition.
   7019 /// E.g.,
   7020 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
   7021 /// b = extractelement <2 x i32> a, i32 0
   7022 /// c = scalar_op b
   7023 /// store c
   7024 ///
   7025 /// =>
   7026 /// a = vector_op <2 x i32>
   7027 /// c = vector_op a (equivalent to scalar_op on the related lane)
   7028 /// * d = extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0
   7029 /// * store d
   7030 /// Assuming both extractelement and store can be combine, we get rid of the
   7031 /// transition.
   7032 class VectorPromoteHelper {
   7033   /// DataLayout associated with the current module.
   7034   const DataLayout &DL;
   7035 
   7036   /// Used to perform some checks on the legality of vector operations.
   7037   const TargetLowering &TLI;
   7038 
   7039   /// Used to estimated the cost of the promoted chain.
   7040   const TargetTransformInfo &TTI;
   7041 
   7042   /// The transition being moved downwards.
   7043   Instruction *Transition;
   7044 
   7045   /// The sequence of instructions to be promoted.
   7046   SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> InstsToBePromoted;
   7047 
   7048   /// Cost of combining a store and an extract.
   7049   unsigned StoreExtractCombineCost;
   7050 
   7051   /// Instruction that will be combined with the transition.
   7052   Instruction *CombineInst = nullptr;
   7053 
   7054   /// The instruction that represents the current end of the transition.
   7055   /// Since we are faking the promotion until we reach the end of the chain
   7056   /// of computation, we need a way to get the current end of the transition.
   7057   Instruction *getEndOfTransition() const {
   7058     if (InstsToBePromoted.empty())
   7059       return Transition;
   7060     return InstsToBePromoted.back();
   7061   }
   7062 
   7063   /// Return the index of the original value in the transition.
   7064   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the original value,
   7065   /// c, is at index 0.
   7066   unsigned getTransitionOriginalValueIdx() const {
   7067     assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
   7068            "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
   7069     return 0;
   7070   }
   7071 
   7072   /// Return the index of the index in the transition.
   7073   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 0" the index
   7074   /// is at index 1.
   7075   unsigned getTransitionIdx() const {
   7076     assert(isa<ExtractElementInst>(Transition) &&
   7077            "Other kind of transitions are not supported yet");
   7078     return 1;
   7079   }
   7080 
   7081   /// Get the type of the transition.
   7082   /// This is the type of the original value.
   7083   /// E.g., for "extractelement <2 x i32> c, i32 1" the type of the
   7084   /// transition is <2 x i32>.
   7085   Type *getTransitionType() const {
   7086     return Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx())->getType();
   7087   }
   7088 
   7089   /// Promote \p ToBePromoted by moving \p Def downward through.
   7090   /// I.e., we have the following sequence:
   7091   /// Def = Transition <ty1> a to <ty2>
   7092   /// b = ToBePromoted <ty2> Def, ...
   7093   /// =>
   7094   /// b = ToBePromoted <ty1> a, ...
   7095   /// Def = Transition <ty1> ToBePromoted to <ty2>
   7096   void promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted);
   7097 
   7098   /// Check whether or not it is profitable to promote all the
   7099   /// instructions enqueued to be promoted.
   7100   bool isProfitableToPromote() {
   7101     Value *ValIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
   7102     unsigned Index = isa<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)
   7103                          ? cast<ConstantInt>(ValIdx)->getZExtValue()
   7104                          : -1;
   7105     Type *PromotedType = getTransitionType();
   7106 
   7107     StoreInst *ST = cast<StoreInst>(CombineInst);
   7108     unsigned AS = ST->getPointerAddressSpace();
   7109     // Check if this store is supported.
   7110     if (!TLI.allowsMisalignedMemoryAccesses(
   7111             TLI.getValueType(DL, ST->getValueOperand()->getType()), AS,
   7112             ST->getAlign())) {
   7113       // If this is not supported, there is no way we can combine
   7114       // the extract with the store.
   7115       return false;
   7116     }
   7117 
   7118     // The scalar chain of computation has to pay for the transition
   7119     // scalar to vector.
   7120     // The vector chain has to account for the combining cost.
   7121     InstructionCost ScalarCost =
   7122         TTI.getVectorInstrCost(Transition->getOpcode(), PromotedType, Index);
   7123     InstructionCost VectorCost = StoreExtractCombineCost;
   7124     enum TargetTransformInfo::TargetCostKind CostKind =
   7125       TargetTransformInfo::TCK_RecipThroughput;
   7126     for (const auto &Inst : InstsToBePromoted) {
   7127       // Compute the cost.
   7128       // By construction, all instructions being promoted are arithmetic ones.
   7129       // Moreover, one argument is a constant that can be viewed as a splat
   7130       // constant.
   7131       Value *Arg0 = Inst->getOperand(0);
   7132       bool IsArg0Constant = isa<UndefValue>(Arg0) || isa<ConstantInt>(Arg0) ||
   7133                             isa<ConstantFP>(Arg0);
   7134       TargetTransformInfo::OperandValueKind Arg0OVK =
   7135           IsArg0Constant ? TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue
   7136                          : TargetTransformInfo::OK_AnyValue;
   7137       TargetTransformInfo::OperandValueKind Arg1OVK =
   7138           !IsArg0Constant ? TargetTransformInfo::OK_UniformConstantValue
   7139                           : TargetTransformInfo::OK_AnyValue;
   7140       ScalarCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(
   7141           Inst->getOpcode(), Inst->getType(), CostKind, Arg0OVK, Arg1OVK);
   7142       VectorCost += TTI.getArithmeticInstrCost(Inst->getOpcode(), PromotedType,
   7143                                                CostKind,
   7144                                                Arg0OVK, Arg1OVK);
   7145     }
   7146     LLVM_DEBUG(
   7147         dbgs() << "Estimated cost of computation to be promoted:\nScalar: "
   7148                << ScalarCost << "\nVector: " << VectorCost << '\n');
   7149     return ScalarCost > VectorCost;
   7150   }
   7151 
   7152   /// Generate a constant vector with \p Val with the same
   7153   /// number of elements as the transition.
   7154   /// \p UseSplat defines whether or not \p Val should be replicated
   7155   /// across the whole vector.
   7156   /// In other words, if UseSplat == true, we generate <Val, Val, ..., Val>,
   7157   /// otherwise we generate a vector with as many undef as possible:
   7158   /// <undef, ..., undef, Val, undef, ..., undef> where \p Val is only
   7159   /// used at the index of the extract.
   7160   Value *getConstantVector(Constant *Val, bool UseSplat) const {
   7161     unsigned ExtractIdx = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
   7162     if (!UseSplat) {
   7163       // If we cannot determine where the constant must be, we have to
   7164       // use a splat constant.
   7165       Value *ValExtractIdx = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionIdx());
   7166       if (ConstantInt *CstVal = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ValExtractIdx))
   7167         ExtractIdx = CstVal->getSExtValue();
   7168       else
   7169         UseSplat = true;
   7170     }
   7171 
   7172     ElementCount EC = cast<VectorType>(getTransitionType())->getElementCount();
   7173     if (UseSplat)
   7174       return ConstantVector::getSplat(EC, Val);
   7175 
   7176     if (!EC.isScalable()) {
   7177       SmallVector<Constant *, 4> ConstVec;
   7178       UndefValue *UndefVal = UndefValue::get(Val->getType());
   7179       for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx != EC.getKnownMinValue(); ++Idx) {
   7180         if (Idx == ExtractIdx)
   7181           ConstVec.push_back(Val);
   7182         else
   7183           ConstVec.push_back(UndefVal);
   7184       }
   7185       return ConstantVector::get(ConstVec);
   7186     } else
   7187       llvm_unreachable(
   7188           "Generate scalable vector for non-splat is unimplemented");
   7189   }
   7190 
   7191   /// Check if promoting to a vector type an operand at \p OperandIdx
   7192   /// in \p Use can trigger undefined behavior.
   7193   static bool canCauseUndefinedBehavior(const Instruction *Use,
   7194                                         unsigned OperandIdx) {
   7195     // This is not safe to introduce undef when the operand is on
   7196     // the right hand side of a division-like instruction.
   7197     if (OperandIdx != 1)
   7198       return false;
   7199     switch (Use->getOpcode()) {
   7200     default:
   7201       return false;
   7202     case Instruction::SDiv:
   7203     case Instruction::UDiv:
   7204     case Instruction::SRem:
   7205     case Instruction::URem:
   7206       return true;
   7207     case Instruction::FDiv:
   7208     case Instruction::FRem:
   7209       return !Use->hasNoNaNs();
   7210     }
   7211     llvm_unreachable(nullptr);
   7212   }
   7213 
   7214 public:
   7215   VectorPromoteHelper(const DataLayout &DL, const TargetLowering &TLI,
   7216                       const TargetTransformInfo &TTI, Instruction *Transition,
   7217                       unsigned CombineCost)
   7218       : DL(DL), TLI(TLI), TTI(TTI), Transition(Transition),
   7219         StoreExtractCombineCost(CombineCost) {
   7220     assert(Transition && "Do not know how to promote null");
   7221   }
   7222 
   7223   /// Check if we can promote \p ToBePromoted to \p Type.
   7224   bool canPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
   7225     // We could support CastInst too.
   7226     return isa<BinaryOperator>(ToBePromoted);
   7227   }
   7228 
   7229   /// Check if it is profitable to promote \p ToBePromoted
   7230   /// by moving downward the transition through.
   7231   bool shouldPromote(const Instruction *ToBePromoted) const {
   7232     // Promote only if all the operands can be statically expanded.
   7233     // Indeed, we do not want to introduce any new kind of transitions.
   7234     for (const Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
   7235       const Value *Val = U.get();
   7236       if (Val == getEndOfTransition()) {
   7237         // If the use is a division and the transition is on the rhs,
   7238         // we cannot promote the operation, otherwise we may create a
   7239         // division by zero.
   7240         if (canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()))
   7241           return false;
   7242         continue;
   7243       }
   7244       if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Val) && !isa<UndefValue>(Val) &&
   7245           !isa<ConstantFP>(Val))
   7246         return false;
   7247     }
   7248     // Check that the resulting operation is legal.
   7249     int ISDOpcode = TLI.InstructionOpcodeToISD(ToBePromoted->getOpcode());
   7250     if (!ISDOpcode)
   7251       return false;
   7252     return StressStoreExtract ||
   7253            TLI.isOperationLegalOrCustom(
   7254                ISDOpcode, TLI.getValueType(DL, getTransitionType(), true));
   7255   }
   7256 
   7257   /// Check whether or not \p Use can be combined
   7258   /// with the transition.
   7259   /// I.e., is it possible to do Use(Transition) => AnotherUse?
   7260   bool canCombine(const Instruction *Use) { return isa<StoreInst>(Use); }
   7261 
   7262   /// Record \p ToBePromoted as part of the chain to be promoted.
   7263   void enqueueForPromotion(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
   7264     InstsToBePromoted.push_back(ToBePromoted);
   7265   }
   7266 
   7267   /// Set the instruction that will be combined with the transition.
   7268   void recordCombineInstruction(Instruction *ToBeCombined) {
   7269     assert(canCombine(ToBeCombined) && "Unsupported instruction to combine");
   7270     CombineInst = ToBeCombined;
   7271   }
   7272 
   7273   /// Promote all the instructions enqueued for promotion if it is
   7274   /// is profitable.
   7275   /// \return True if the promotion happened, false otherwise.
   7276   bool promote() {
   7277     // Check if there is something to promote.
   7278     // Right now, if we do not have anything to combine with,
   7279     // we assume the promotion is not profitable.
   7280     if (InstsToBePromoted.empty() || !CombineInst)
   7281       return false;
   7282 
   7283     // Check cost.
   7284     if (!StressStoreExtract && !isProfitableToPromote())
   7285       return false;
   7286 
   7287     // Promote.
   7288     for (auto &ToBePromoted : InstsToBePromoted)
   7289       promoteImpl(ToBePromoted);
   7290     InstsToBePromoted.clear();
   7291     return true;
   7292   }
   7293 };
   7294 
   7295 } // end anonymous namespace
   7296 
   7297 void VectorPromoteHelper::promoteImpl(Instruction *ToBePromoted) {
   7298   // At this point, we know that all the operands of ToBePromoted but Def
   7299   // can be statically promoted.
   7300   // For Def, we need to use its parameter in ToBePromoted:
   7301   // b = ToBePromoted ty1 a
   7302   // Def = Transition ty1 b to ty2
   7303   // Move the transition down.
   7304   // 1. Replace all uses of the promoted operation by the transition.
   7305   // = ... b => = ... Def.
   7306   assert(ToBePromoted->getType() == Transition->getType() &&
   7307          "The type of the result of the transition does not match "
   7308          "the final type");
   7309   ToBePromoted->replaceAllUsesWith(Transition);
   7310   // 2. Update the type of the uses.
   7311   // b = ToBePromoted ty2 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def.
   7312   Type *TransitionTy = getTransitionType();
   7313   ToBePromoted->mutateType(TransitionTy);
   7314   // 3. Update all the operands of the promoted operation with promoted
   7315   // operands.
   7316   // b = ToBePromoted ty1 Def => b = ToBePromoted ty1 a.
   7317   for (Use &U : ToBePromoted->operands()) {
   7318     Value *Val = U.get();
   7319     Value *NewVal = nullptr;
   7320     if (Val == Transition)
   7321       NewVal = Transition->getOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx());
   7322     else if (isa<UndefValue>(Val) || isa<ConstantInt>(Val) ||
   7323              isa<ConstantFP>(Val)) {
   7324       // Use a splat constant if it is not safe to use undef.
   7325       NewVal = getConstantVector(
   7326           cast<Constant>(Val),
   7327           isa<UndefValue>(Val) ||
   7328               canCauseUndefinedBehavior(ToBePromoted, U.getOperandNo()));
   7329     } else
   7330       llvm_unreachable("Did you modified shouldPromote and forgot to update "
   7331                        "this?");
   7332     ToBePromoted->setOperand(U.getOperandNo(), NewVal);
   7333   }
   7334   Transition->moveAfter(ToBePromoted);
   7335   Transition->setOperand(getTransitionOriginalValueIdx(), ToBePromoted);
   7336 }
   7337 
   7338 /// Some targets can do store(extractelement) with one instruction.
   7339 /// Try to push the extractelement towards the stores when the target
   7340 /// has this feature and this is profitable.
   7341 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeExtractElementInst(Instruction *Inst) {
   7342   unsigned CombineCost = std::numeric_limits<unsigned>::max();
   7343   if (DisableStoreExtract ||
   7344       (!StressStoreExtract &&
   7345        !TLI->canCombineStoreAndExtract(Inst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
   7346                                        Inst->getOperand(1), CombineCost)))
   7347     return false;
   7348 
   7349   // At this point we know that Inst is a vector to scalar transition.
   7350   // Try to move it down the def-use chain, until:
   7351   // - We can combine the transition with its single use
   7352   //   => we got rid of the transition.
   7353   // - We escape the current basic block
   7354   //   => we would need to check that we are moving it at a cheaper place and
   7355   //      we do not do that for now.
   7356   BasicBlock *Parent = Inst->getParent();
   7357   LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Found an interesting transition: " << *Inst << '\n');
   7358   VectorPromoteHelper VPH(*DL, *TLI, *TTI, Inst, CombineCost);
   7359   // If the transition has more than one use, assume this is not going to be
   7360   // beneficial.
   7361   while (Inst->hasOneUse()) {
   7362     Instruction *ToBePromoted = cast<Instruction>(*Inst->user_begin());
   7363     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Use: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
   7364 
   7365     if (ToBePromoted->getParent() != Parent) {
   7366       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Instruction to promote is in a different block ("
   7367                         << ToBePromoted->getParent()->getName()
   7368                         << ") than the transition (" << Parent->getName()
   7369                         << ").\n");
   7370       return false;
   7371     }
   7372 
   7373     if (VPH.canCombine(ToBePromoted)) {
   7374       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Assume " << *Inst << '\n'
   7375                         << "will be combined with: " << *ToBePromoted << '\n');
   7376       VPH.recordCombineInstruction(ToBePromoted);
   7377       bool Changed = VPH.promote();
   7378       NumStoreExtractExposed += Changed;
   7379       return Changed;
   7380     }
   7381 
   7382     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Try promoting.\n");
   7383     if (!VPH.canPromote(ToBePromoted) || !VPH.shouldPromote(ToBePromoted))
   7384       return false;
   7385 
   7386     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Promoting is possible... Enqueue for promotion!\n");
   7387 
   7388     VPH.enqueueForPromotion(ToBePromoted);
   7389     Inst = ToBePromoted;
   7390   }
   7391   return false;
   7392 }
   7393 
   7394 /// For the instruction sequence of store below, F and I values
   7395 /// are bundled together as an i64 value before being stored into memory.
   7396 /// Sometimes it is more efficient to generate separate stores for F and I,
   7397 /// which can remove the bitwise instructions or sink them to colder places.
   7398 ///
   7399 ///   (store (or (zext (bitcast F to i32) to i64),
   7400 ///              (shl (zext I to i64), 32)), addr)  -->
   7401 ///   (store F, addr) and (store I, addr+4)
   7402 ///
   7403 /// Similarly, splitting for other merged store can also be beneficial, like:
   7404 /// For pair of {i32, i32}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
   7405 /// For pair of {i32, i16}, i64 store --> two i32 stores.
   7406 /// For pair of {i16, i16}, i32 store --> two i16 stores.
   7407 /// For pair of {i16, i8},  i32 store --> two i16 stores.
   7408 /// For pair of {i8, i8},   i16 store --> two i8 stores.
   7409 ///
   7410 /// We allow each target to determine specifically which kind of splitting is
   7411 /// supported.
   7412 ///
   7413 /// The store patterns are commonly seen from the simple code snippet below
   7414 /// if only std::make_pair(...) is sroa transformed before inlined into hoo.
   7415 ///   void goo(const std::pair<int, float> &);
   7416 ///   hoo() {
   7417 ///     ...
   7418 ///     goo(std::make_pair(tmp, ftmp));
   7419 ///     ...
   7420 ///   }
   7421 ///
   7422 /// Although we already have similar splitting in DAG Combine, we duplicate
   7423 /// it in CodeGenPrepare to catch the case in which pattern is across
   7424 /// multiple BBs. The logic in DAG Combine is kept to catch case generated
   7425 /// during code expansion.
   7426 static bool splitMergedValStore(StoreInst &SI, const DataLayout &DL,
   7427                                 const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   7428   // Handle simple but common cases only.
   7429   Type *StoreType = SI.getValueOperand()->getType();
   7430 
   7431   // The code below assumes shifting a value by <number of bits>,
   7432   // whereas scalable vectors would have to be shifted by
   7433   // <2log(vscale) + number of bits> in order to store the
   7434   // low/high parts. Bailing out for now.
   7435   if (isa<ScalableVectorType>(StoreType))
   7436     return false;
   7437 
   7438   if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(StoreType) ||
   7439       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) == 0)
   7440     return false;
   7441 
   7442   unsigned HalfValBitSize = DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StoreType) / 2;
   7443   Type *SplitStoreType = Type::getIntNTy(SI.getContext(), HalfValBitSize);
   7444   if (!DL.typeSizeEqualsStoreSize(SplitStoreType))
   7445     return false;
   7446 
   7447   // Don't split the store if it is volatile.
   7448   if (SI.isVolatile())
   7449     return false;
   7450 
   7451   // Match the following patterns:
   7452   // (store (or (zext LValue to i64),
   7453   //            (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
   7454   //  or
   7455   // (store (or (shl (zext HValue to i64), 32)), HalfValBitSize)
   7456   //            (zext LValue to i64),
   7457   // Expect both operands of OR and the first operand of SHL have only
   7458   // one use.
   7459   Value *LValue, *HValue;
   7460   if (!match(SI.getValueOperand(),
   7461              m_c_Or(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(LValue))),
   7462                     m_OneUse(m_Shl(m_OneUse(m_ZExt(m_Value(HValue))),
   7463                                    m_SpecificInt(HalfValBitSize))))))
   7464     return false;
   7465 
   7466   // Check LValue and HValue are int with size less or equal than 32.
   7467   if (!LValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
   7468       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(LValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize ||
   7469       !HValue->getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
   7470       DL.getTypeSizeInBits(HValue->getType()) > HalfValBitSize)
   7471     return false;
   7472 
   7473   // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast instruction, use the EVT before bitcast
   7474   // as the input of target query.
   7475   auto *LBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(LValue);
   7476   auto *HBC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(HValue);
   7477   EVT LowTy = LBC ? EVT::getEVT(LBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
   7478                   : EVT::getEVT(LValue->getType());
   7479   EVT HighTy = HBC ? EVT::getEVT(HBC->getOperand(0)->getType())
   7480                    : EVT::getEVT(HValue->getType());
   7481   if (!ForceSplitStore && !TLI.isMultiStoresCheaperThanBitsMerge(LowTy, HighTy))
   7482     return false;
   7483 
   7484   // Start to split store.
   7485   IRBuilder<> Builder(SI.getContext());
   7486   Builder.SetInsertPoint(&SI);
   7487 
   7488   // If LValue/HValue is a bitcast in another BB, create a new one in current
   7489   // BB so it may be merged with the splitted stores by dag combiner.
   7490   if (LBC && LBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
   7491     LValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(LBC->getOperand(0), LBC->getType());
   7492   if (HBC && HBC->getParent() != SI.getParent())
   7493     HValue = Builder.CreateBitCast(HBC->getOperand(0), HBC->getType());
   7494 
   7495   bool IsLE = SI.getModule()->getDataLayout().isLittleEndian();
   7496   auto CreateSplitStore = [&](Value *V, bool Upper) {
   7497     V = Builder.CreateZExtOrBitCast(V, SplitStoreType);
   7498     Value *Addr = Builder.CreateBitCast(
   7499         SI.getOperand(1),
   7500         SplitStoreType->getPointerTo(SI.getPointerAddressSpace()));
   7501     Align Alignment = SI.getAlign();
   7502     const bool IsOffsetStore = (IsLE && Upper) || (!IsLE && !Upper);
   7503     if (IsOffsetStore) {
   7504       Addr = Builder.CreateGEP(
   7505           SplitStoreType, Addr,
   7506           ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SI.getContext()), 1));
   7507 
   7508       // When splitting the store in half, naturally one half will retain the
   7509       // alignment of the original wider store, regardless of whether it was
   7510       // over-aligned or not, while the other will require adjustment.
   7511       Alignment = commonAlignment(Alignment, HalfValBitSize / 8);
   7512     }
   7513     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(V, Addr, Alignment);
   7514   };
   7515 
   7516   CreateSplitStore(LValue, false);
   7517   CreateSplitStore(HValue, true);
   7518 
   7519   // Delete the old store.
   7520   SI.eraseFromParent();
   7521   return true;
   7522 }
   7523 
   7524 // Return true if the GEP has two operands, the first operand is of a sequential
   7525 // type, and the second operand is a constant.
   7526 static bool GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GetElementPtrInst *GEP) {
   7527   gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*GEP);
   7528   return GEP->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
   7529       I.isSequential() &&
   7530       isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(1));
   7531 }
   7532 
   7533 // Try unmerging GEPs to reduce liveness interference (register pressure) across
   7534 // IndirectBr edges. Since IndirectBr edges tend to touch on many blocks,
   7535 // reducing liveness interference across those edges benefits global register
   7536 // allocation. Currently handles only certain cases.
   7537 //
   7538 // For example, unmerge %GEPI and %UGEPI as below.
   7539 //
   7540 // ---------- BEFORE ----------
   7541 // SrcBlock:
   7542 //   ...
   7543 //   %GEPIOp = ...
   7544 //   ...
   7545 //   %GEPI = gep %GEPIOp, Idx
   7546 //   ...
   7547 //   indirectbr ... [ label %DstB0, label %DstB1, ... label %DstBi ... ]
   7548 //   (* %GEPI is alive on the indirectbr edges due to other uses ahead)
   7549 //   (* %GEPIOp is alive on the indirectbr edges only because of it's used by
   7550 //   %UGEPI)
   7551 //
   7552 // DstB0: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
   7553 // DstB1: ... (there may be a gep similar to %UGEPI to be unmerged)
   7554 // ...
   7555 //
   7556 // DstBi:
   7557 //   ...
   7558 //   %UGEPI = gep %GEPIOp, UIdx
   7559 // ...
   7560 // ---------------------------
   7561 //
   7562 // ---------- AFTER ----------
   7563 // SrcBlock:
   7564 //   ... (same as above)
   7565 //    (* %GEPI is still alive on the indirectbr edges)
   7566 //    (* %GEPIOp is no longer alive on the indirectbr edges as a result of the
   7567 //    unmerging)
   7568 // ...
   7569 //
   7570 // DstBi:
   7571 //   ...
   7572 //   %UGEPI = gep %GEPI, (UIdx-Idx)
   7573 //   ...
   7574 // ---------------------------
   7575 //
   7576 // The register pressure on the IndirectBr edges is reduced because %GEPIOp is
   7577 // no longer alive on them.
   7578 //
   7579 // We try to unmerge GEPs here in CodGenPrepare, as opposed to limiting merging
   7580 // of GEPs in the first place in InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst() so as
   7581 // not to disable further simplications and optimizations as a result of GEP
   7582 // merging.
   7583 //
   7584 // Note this unmerging may increase the length of the data flow critical path
   7585 // (the path from %GEPIOp to %UGEPI would go through %GEPI), which is a tradeoff
   7586 // between the register pressure and the length of data-flow critical
   7587 // path. Restricting this to the uncommon IndirectBr case would minimize the
   7588 // impact of potentially longer critical path, if any, and the impact on compile
   7589 // time.
   7590 static bool tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GetElementPtrInst *GEPI,
   7591                                              const TargetTransformInfo *TTI) {
   7592   BasicBlock *SrcBlock = GEPI->getParent();
   7593   // Check that SrcBlock ends with an IndirectBr. If not, give up. The common
   7594   // (non-IndirectBr) cases exit early here.
   7595   if (!isa<IndirectBrInst>(SrcBlock->getTerminator()))
   7596     return false;
   7597   // Check that GEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index.
   7598   if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(GEPI))
   7599     return false;
   7600   ConstantInt *GEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(GEPI->getOperand(1));
   7601   // Check that GEPI is a cheap one.
   7602   if (TTI->getIntImmCost(GEPIIdx->getValue(), GEPIIdx->getType(),
   7603                          TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency)
   7604       > TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
   7605     return false;
   7606   Value *GEPIOp = GEPI->getOperand(0);
   7607   // Check that GEPIOp is an instruction that's also defined in SrcBlock.
   7608   if (!isa<Instruction>(GEPIOp))
   7609     return false;
   7610   auto *GEPIOpI = cast<Instruction>(GEPIOp);
   7611   if (GEPIOpI->getParent() != SrcBlock)
   7612     return false;
   7613   // Check that GEP is used outside the block, meaning it's alive on the
   7614   // IndirectBr edge(s).
   7615   if (find_if(GEPI->users(), [&](User *Usr) {
   7616         if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Usr)) {
   7617           if (I->getParent() != SrcBlock) {
   7618             return true;
   7619           }
   7620         }
   7621         return false;
   7622       }) == GEPI->users().end())
   7623     return false;
   7624   // The second elements of the GEP chains to be unmerged.
   7625   std::vector<GetElementPtrInst *> UGEPIs;
   7626   // Check each user of GEPIOp to check if unmerging would make GEPIOp not alive
   7627   // on IndirectBr edges.
   7628   for (User *Usr : GEPIOp->users()) {
   7629     if (Usr == GEPI) continue;
   7630     // Check if Usr is an Instruction. If not, give up.
   7631     if (!isa<Instruction>(Usr))
   7632       return false;
   7633     auto *UI = cast<Instruction>(Usr);
   7634     // Check if Usr in the same block as GEPIOp, which is fine, skip.
   7635     if (UI->getParent() == SrcBlock)
   7636       continue;
   7637     // Check if Usr is a GEP. If not, give up.
   7638     if (!isa<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr))
   7639       return false;
   7640     auto *UGEPI = cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Usr);
   7641     // Check if UGEPI is a simple gep with a single constant index and GEPIOp is
   7642     // the pointer operand to it. If so, record it in the vector. If not, give
   7643     // up.
   7644     if (!GEPSequentialConstIndexed(UGEPI))
   7645       return false;
   7646     if (UGEPI->getOperand(0) != GEPIOp)
   7647       return false;
   7648     if (GEPIIdx->getType() !=
   7649         cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1))->getType())
   7650       return false;
   7651     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
   7652     if (TTI->getIntImmCost(UGEPIIdx->getValue(), UGEPIIdx->getType(),
   7653                            TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency)
   7654         > TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
   7655       return false;
   7656     UGEPIs.push_back(UGEPI);
   7657   }
   7658   if (UGEPIs.size() == 0)
   7659     return false;
   7660   // Check the materializing cost of (Uidx-Idx).
   7661   for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
   7662     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
   7663     APInt NewIdx = UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue();
   7664     InstructionCost ImmCost = TTI->getIntImmCost(
   7665         NewIdx, GEPIIdx->getType(), TargetTransformInfo::TCK_SizeAndLatency);
   7666     if (ImmCost > TargetTransformInfo::TCC_Basic)
   7667       return false;
   7668   }
   7669   // Now unmerge between GEPI and UGEPIs.
   7670   for (GetElementPtrInst *UGEPI : UGEPIs) {
   7671     UGEPI->setOperand(0, GEPI);
   7672     ConstantInt *UGEPIIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(UGEPI->getOperand(1));
   7673     Constant *NewUGEPIIdx =
   7674         ConstantInt::get(GEPIIdx->getType(),
   7675                          UGEPIIdx->getValue() - GEPIIdx->getValue());
   7676     UGEPI->setOperand(1, NewUGEPIIdx);
   7677     // If GEPI is not inbounds but UGEPI is inbounds, change UGEPI to not
   7678     // inbounds to avoid UB.
   7679     if (!GEPI->isInBounds()) {
   7680       UGEPI->setIsInBounds(false);
   7681     }
   7682   }
   7683   // After unmerging, verify that GEPIOp is actually only used in SrcBlock (not
   7684   // alive on IndirectBr edges).
   7685   assert(find_if(GEPIOp->users(), [&](User *Usr) {
   7686         return cast<Instruction>(Usr)->getParent() != SrcBlock;
   7687       }) == GEPIOp->users().end() && "GEPIOp is used outside SrcBlock");
   7688   return true;
   7689 }
   7690 
   7691 static bool optimizeBranch(BranchInst *Branch, const TargetLowering &TLI) {
   7692   // Try and convert
   7693   //  %c = icmp ult %x, 8
   7694   //  br %c, bla, blb
   7695   //  %tc = lshr %x, 3
   7696   // to
   7697   //  %tc = lshr %x, 3
   7698   //  %c = icmp eq %tc, 0
   7699   //  br %c, bla, blb
   7700   // Creating the cmp to zero can be better for the backend, especially if the
   7701   // lshr produces flags that can be used automatically.
   7702   if (!TLI.preferZeroCompareBranch() || !Branch->isConditional())
   7703     return false;
   7704 
   7705   ICmpInst *Cmp = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Branch->getCondition());
   7706   if (!Cmp || !isa<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1)) || !Cmp->hasOneUse())
   7707     return false;
   7708 
   7709   Value *X = Cmp->getOperand(0);
   7710   APInt CmpC = cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp->getOperand(1))->getValue();
   7711 
   7712   for (auto *U : X->users()) {
   7713     Instruction *UI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(U);
   7714     // A quick dominance check
   7715     if (!UI ||
   7716         (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
   7717          UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(0) &&
   7718          UI->getParent() != Branch->getSuccessor(1)) ||
   7719         (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent() &&
   7720          !UI->getParent()->getSinglePredecessor()))
   7721       continue;
   7722 
   7723     if (CmpC.isPowerOf2() && Cmp->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
   7724         match(UI, m_Shr(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC.logBase2())))) {
   7725       IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
   7726       if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
   7727         UI->moveBefore(Branch);
   7728       Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, UI,
   7729                                         ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
   7730       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
   7731       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
   7732       Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCmp);
   7733       return true;
   7734     }
   7735     if (Cmp->isEquality() &&
   7736         (match(UI, m_Add(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(-CmpC))) ||
   7737          match(UI, m_Sub(m_Specific(X), m_SpecificInt(CmpC))))) {
   7738       IRBuilder<> Builder(Branch);
   7739       if (UI->getParent() != Branch->getParent())
   7740         UI->moveBefore(Branch);
   7741       Value *NewCmp = Builder.CreateCmp(Cmp->getPredicate(), UI,
   7742                                         ConstantInt::get(UI->getType(), 0));
   7743       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Converting " << *Cmp << "\n");
   7744       LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << " to compare on zero: " << *NewCmp << "\n");
   7745       Cmp->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCmp);
   7746       return true;
   7747     }
   7748   }
   7749   return false;
   7750 }
   7751 
   7752 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeInst(Instruction *I, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   7753   // Bail out if we inserted the instruction to prevent optimizations from
   7754   // stepping on each other's toes.
   7755   if (InsertedInsts.count(I))
   7756     return false;
   7757 
   7758   // TODO: Move into the switch on opcode below here.
   7759   if (PHINode *P = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I)) {
   7760     // It is possible for very late stage optimizations (such as SimplifyCFG)
   7761     // to introduce PHI nodes too late to be cleaned up.  If we detect such a
   7762     // trivial PHI, go ahead and zap it here.
   7763     if (Value *V = SimplifyInstruction(P, {*DL, TLInfo})) {
   7764       LargeOffsetGEPMap.erase(P);
   7765       P->replaceAllUsesWith(V);
   7766       P->eraseFromParent();
   7767       ++NumPHIsElim;
   7768       return true;
   7769     }
   7770     return false;
   7771   }
   7772 
   7773   if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
   7774     // If the source of the cast is a constant, then this should have
   7775     // already been constant folded.  The only reason NOT to constant fold
   7776     // it is if something (e.g. LSR) was careful to place the constant
   7777     // evaluation in a block other than then one that uses it (e.g. to hoist
   7778     // the address of globals out of a loop).  If this is the case, we don't
   7779     // want to forward-subst the cast.
   7780     if (isa<Constant>(CI->getOperand(0)))
   7781       return false;
   7782 
   7783     if (OptimizeNoopCopyExpression(CI, *TLI, *DL))
   7784       return true;
   7785 
   7786     if (isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
   7787       /// Sink a zext or sext into its user blocks if the target type doesn't
   7788       /// fit in one register
   7789       if (TLI->getTypeAction(CI->getContext(),
   7790                              TLI->getValueType(*DL, CI->getType())) ==
   7791           TargetLowering::TypeExpandInteger) {
   7792         return SinkCast(CI);
   7793       } else {
   7794         bool MadeChange = optimizeExt(I);
   7795         return MadeChange | optimizeExtUses(I);
   7796       }
   7797     }
   7798     return false;
   7799   }
   7800 
   7801   if (auto *Cmp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
   7802     if (optimizeCmp(Cmp, ModifiedDT))
   7803       return true;
   7804 
   7805   if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
   7806     LI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
   7807     bool Modified = optimizeLoadExt(LI);
   7808     unsigned AS = LI->getPointerAddressSpace();
   7809     Modified |= optimizeMemoryInst(I, I->getOperand(0), LI->getType(), AS);
   7810     return Modified;
   7811   }
   7812 
   7813   if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(I)) {
   7814     if (splitMergedValStore(*SI, *DL, *TLI))
   7815       return true;
   7816     SI->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_invariant_group, nullptr);
   7817     unsigned AS = SI->getPointerAddressSpace();
   7818     return optimizeMemoryInst(I, SI->getOperand(1),
   7819                               SI->getOperand(0)->getType(), AS);
   7820   }
   7821 
   7822   if (AtomicRMWInst *RMW = dyn_cast<AtomicRMWInst>(I)) {
   7823       unsigned AS = RMW->getPointerAddressSpace();
   7824       return optimizeMemoryInst(I, RMW->getPointerOperand(),
   7825                                 RMW->getType(), AS);
   7826   }
   7827 
   7828   if (AtomicCmpXchgInst *CmpX = dyn_cast<AtomicCmpXchgInst>(I)) {
   7829       unsigned AS = CmpX->getPointerAddressSpace();
   7830       return optimizeMemoryInst(I, CmpX->getPointerOperand(),
   7831                                 CmpX->getCompareOperand()->getType(), AS);
   7832   }
   7833 
   7834   BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I);
   7835 
   7836   if (BinOp && (BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) && EnableAndCmpSinking)
   7837     return sinkAndCmp0Expression(BinOp, *TLI, InsertedInsts);
   7838 
   7839   // TODO: Move this into the switch on opcode - it handles shifts already.
   7840   if (BinOp && (BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr ||
   7841                 BinOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)) {
   7842     ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BinOp->getOperand(1));
   7843     if (CI && TLI->hasExtractBitsInsn())
   7844       if (OptimizeExtractBits(BinOp, CI, *TLI, *DL))
   7845         return true;
   7846   }
   7847 
   7848   if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(I)) {
   7849     if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
   7850       /// The GEP operand must be a pointer, so must its result -> BitCast
   7851       Instruction *NC = new BitCastInst(GEPI->getOperand(0), GEPI->getType(),
   7852                                         GEPI->getName(), GEPI);
   7853       NC->setDebugLoc(GEPI->getDebugLoc());
   7854       GEPI->replaceAllUsesWith(NC);
   7855       GEPI->eraseFromParent();
   7856       ++NumGEPsElim;
   7857       optimizeInst(NC, ModifiedDT);
   7858       return true;
   7859     }
   7860     if (tryUnmergingGEPsAcrossIndirectBr(GEPI, TTI)) {
   7861       return true;
   7862     }
   7863     return false;
   7864   }
   7865 
   7866   if (FreezeInst *FI = dyn_cast<FreezeInst>(I)) {
   7867     // freeze(icmp a, const)) -> icmp (freeze a), const
   7868     // This helps generate efficient conditional jumps.
   7869     Instruction *CmpI = nullptr;
   7870     if (ICmpInst *II = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
   7871       CmpI = II;
   7872     else if (FCmpInst *F = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(FI->getOperand(0)))
   7873       CmpI = F->getFastMathFlags().none() ? F : nullptr;
   7874 
   7875     if (CmpI && CmpI->hasOneUse()) {
   7876       auto Op0 = CmpI->getOperand(0), Op1 = CmpI->getOperand(1);
   7877       bool Const0 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op0) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op0) ||
   7878                     isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0);
   7879       bool Const1 = isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<ConstantFP>(Op1) ||
   7880                     isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1);
   7881       if (Const0 || Const1) {
   7882         if (!Const0 || !Const1) {
   7883           auto *F = new FreezeInst(Const0 ? Op1 : Op0, "", CmpI);
   7884           F->takeName(FI);
   7885           CmpI->setOperand(Const0 ? 1 : 0, F);
   7886         }
   7887         FI->replaceAllUsesWith(CmpI);
   7888         FI->eraseFromParent();
   7889         return true;
   7890       }
   7891     }
   7892     return false;
   7893   }
   7894 
   7895   if (tryToSinkFreeOperands(I))
   7896     return true;
   7897 
   7898   switch (I->getOpcode()) {
   7899   case Instruction::Shl:
   7900   case Instruction::LShr:
   7901   case Instruction::AShr:
   7902     return optimizeShiftInst(cast<BinaryOperator>(I));
   7903   case Instruction::Call:
   7904     return optimizeCallInst(cast<CallInst>(I), ModifiedDT);
   7905   case Instruction::Select:
   7906     return optimizeSelectInst(cast<SelectInst>(I));
   7907   case Instruction::ShuffleVector:
   7908     return optimizeShuffleVectorInst(cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I));
   7909   case Instruction::Switch:
   7910     return optimizeSwitchInst(cast<SwitchInst>(I));
   7911   case Instruction::ExtractElement:
   7912     return optimizeExtractElementInst(cast<ExtractElementInst>(I));
   7913   case Instruction::Br:
   7914     return optimizeBranch(cast<BranchInst>(I), *TLI);
   7915   }
   7916 
   7917   return false;
   7918 }
   7919 
   7920 /// Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bitreverse
   7921 /// idiom. If so, insert the new intrinsic and return true.
   7922 bool CodeGenPrepare::makeBitReverse(Instruction &I) {
   7923   if (!I.getType()->isIntegerTy() ||
   7924       !TLI->isOperationLegalOrCustom(ISD::BITREVERSE,
   7925                                      TLI->getValueType(*DL, I.getType(), true)))
   7926     return false;
   7927 
   7928   SmallVector<Instruction*, 4> Insts;
   7929   if (!recognizeBSwapOrBitReverseIdiom(&I, false, true, Insts))
   7930     return false;
   7931   Instruction *LastInst = Insts.back();
   7932   I.replaceAllUsesWith(LastInst);
   7933   RecursivelyDeleteTriviallyDeadInstructions(
   7934       &I, TLInfo, nullptr, [&](Value *V) { removeAllAssertingVHReferences(V); });
   7935   return true;
   7936 }
   7937 
   7938 // In this pass we look for GEP and cast instructions that are used
   7939 // across basic blocks and rewrite them to improve basic-block-at-a-time
   7940 // selection.
   7941 bool CodeGenPrepare::optimizeBlock(BasicBlock &BB, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   7942   SunkAddrs.clear();
   7943   bool MadeChange = false;
   7944 
   7945   CurInstIterator = BB.begin();
   7946   while (CurInstIterator != BB.end()) {
   7947     MadeChange |= optimizeInst(&*CurInstIterator++, ModifiedDT);
   7948     if (ModifiedDT)
   7949       return true;
   7950   }
   7951 
   7952   bool MadeBitReverse = true;
   7953   while (MadeBitReverse) {
   7954     MadeBitReverse = false;
   7955     for (auto &I : reverse(BB)) {
   7956       if (makeBitReverse(I)) {
   7957         MadeBitReverse = MadeChange = true;
   7958         break;
   7959       }
   7960     }
   7961   }
   7962   MadeChange |= dupRetToEnableTailCallOpts(&BB, ModifiedDT);
   7963 
   7964   return MadeChange;
   7965 }
   7966 
   7967 // Some CGP optimizations may move or alter what's computed in a block. Check
   7968 // whether a dbg.value intrinsic could be pointed at a more appropriate operand.
   7969 bool CodeGenPrepare::fixupDbgValue(Instruction *I) {
   7970   assert(isa<DbgValueInst>(I));
   7971   DbgValueInst &DVI = *cast<DbgValueInst>(I);
   7972 
   7973   // Does this dbg.value refer to a sunk address calculation?
   7974   bool AnyChange = false;
   7975   for (Value *Location : DVI.getValues()) {
   7976     WeakTrackingVH SunkAddrVH = SunkAddrs[Location];
   7977     Value *SunkAddr = SunkAddrVH.pointsToAliveValue() ? SunkAddrVH : nullptr;
   7978     if (SunkAddr) {
   7979       // Point dbg.value at locally computed address, which should give the best
   7980       // opportunity to be accurately lowered. This update may change the type
   7981       // of pointer being referred to; however this makes no difference to
   7982       // debugging information, and we can't generate bitcasts that may affect
   7983       // codegen.
   7984       DVI.replaceVariableLocationOp(Location, SunkAddr);
   7985       AnyChange = true;
   7986     }
   7987   }
   7988   return AnyChange;
   7989 }
   7990 
   7991 // A llvm.dbg.value may be using a value before its definition, due to
   7992 // optimizations in this pass and others. Scan for such dbg.values, and rescue
   7993 // them by moving the dbg.value to immediately after the value definition.
   7994 // FIXME: Ideally this should never be necessary, and this has the potential
   7995 // to re-order dbg.value intrinsics.
   7996 bool CodeGenPrepare::placeDbgValues(Function &F) {
   7997   bool MadeChange = false;
   7998   DominatorTree DT(F);
   7999 
   8000   for (BasicBlock &BB : F) {
   8001     for (BasicBlock::iterator BI = BB.begin(), BE = BB.end(); BI != BE;) {
   8002       Instruction *Insn = &*BI++;
   8003       DbgValueInst *DVI = dyn_cast<DbgValueInst>(Insn);
   8004       if (!DVI)
   8005         continue;
   8006 
   8007       SmallVector<Instruction *, 4> VIs;
   8008       for (Value *V : DVI->getValues())
   8009         if (Instruction *VI = dyn_cast_or_null<Instruction>(V))
   8010           VIs.push_back(VI);
   8011 
   8012       // This DVI may depend on multiple instructions, complicating any
   8013       // potential sink. This block takes the defensive approach, opting to
   8014       // "undef" the DVI if it has more than one instruction and any of them do
   8015       // not dominate DVI.
   8016       for (Instruction *VI : VIs) {
   8017         if (VI->isTerminator())
   8018           continue;
   8019 
   8020         // If VI is a phi in a block with an EHPad terminator, we can't insert
   8021         // after it.
   8022         if (isa<PHINode>(VI) && VI->getParent()->getTerminator()->isEHPad())
   8023           continue;
   8024 
   8025         // If the defining instruction dominates the dbg.value, we do not need
   8026         // to move the dbg.value.
   8027         if (DT.dominates(VI, DVI))
   8028           continue;
   8029 
   8030         // If we depend on multiple instructions and any of them doesn't
   8031         // dominate this DVI, we probably can't salvage it: moving it to
   8032         // after any of the instructions could cause us to lose the others.
   8033         if (VIs.size() > 1) {
   8034           LLVM_DEBUG(
   8035               dbgs()
   8036               << "Unable to find valid location for Debug Value, undefing:\n"
   8037               << *DVI);
   8038           DVI->setUndef();
   8039           break;
   8040         }
   8041 
   8042         LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Moving Debug Value before :\n"
   8043                           << *DVI << ' ' << *VI);
   8044         DVI->removeFromParent();
   8045         if (isa<PHINode>(VI))
   8046           DVI->insertBefore(&*VI->getParent()->getFirstInsertionPt());
   8047         else
   8048           DVI->insertAfter(VI);
   8049         MadeChange = true;
   8050         ++NumDbgValueMoved;
   8051       }
   8052     }
   8053   }
   8054   return MadeChange;
   8055 }
   8056 
   8057 // Group scattered pseudo probes in a block to favor SelectionDAG. Scattered
   8058 // probes can be chained dependencies of other regular DAG nodes and block DAG
   8059 // combine optimizations.
   8060 bool CodeGenPrepare::placePseudoProbes(Function &F) {
   8061   bool MadeChange = false;
   8062   for (auto &Block : F) {
   8063     // Move the rest probes to the beginning of the block.
   8064     auto FirstInst = Block.getFirstInsertionPt();
   8065     while (FirstInst != Block.end() && FirstInst->isDebugOrPseudoInst())
   8066       ++FirstInst;
   8067     BasicBlock::iterator I(FirstInst);
   8068     I++;
   8069     while (I != Block.end()) {
   8070       if (auto *II = dyn_cast<PseudoProbeInst>(I++)) {
   8071         II->moveBefore(&*FirstInst);
   8072         MadeChange = true;
   8073       }
   8074     }
   8075   }
   8076   return MadeChange;
   8077 }
   8078 
   8079 /// Scale down both weights to fit into uint32_t.
   8080 static void scaleWeights(uint64_t &NewTrue, uint64_t &NewFalse) {
   8081   uint64_t NewMax = (NewTrue > NewFalse) ? NewTrue : NewFalse;
   8082   uint32_t Scale = (NewMax / std::numeric_limits<uint32_t>::max()) + 1;
   8083   NewTrue = NewTrue / Scale;
   8084   NewFalse = NewFalse / Scale;
   8085 }
   8086 
   8087 /// Some targets prefer to split a conditional branch like:
   8088 /// \code
   8089 ///   %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
   8090 ///   %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
   8091 ///   %or.cond = or i1 %0, %1
   8092 ///   br i1 %or.cond, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
   8093 /// \endcode
   8094 /// into multiple branch instructions like:
   8095 /// \code
   8096 ///   bb1:
   8097 ///     %0 = icmp ne i32 %a, 0
   8098 ///     br i1 %0, label %TrueBB, label %bb2
   8099 ///   bb2:
   8100 ///     %1 = icmp ne i32 %b, 0
   8101 ///     br i1 %1, label %TrueBB, label %FalseBB
   8102 /// \endcode
   8103 /// This usually allows instruction selection to do even further optimizations
   8104 /// and combine the compare with the branch instruction. Currently this is
   8105 /// applied for targets which have "cheap" jump instructions.
   8106 ///
   8107 /// FIXME: Remove the (equivalent?) implementation in SelectionDAG.
   8108 ///
   8109 bool CodeGenPrepare::splitBranchCondition(Function &F, bool &ModifiedDT) {
   8110   if (!TM->Options.EnableFastISel || TLI->isJumpExpensive())
   8111     return false;
   8112 
   8113   bool MadeChange = false;
   8114   for (auto &BB : F) {
   8115     // Does this BB end with the following?
   8116     //   %cond1 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
   8117     //   %cond2 = icmp|fcmp|binary instruction ...
   8118     //   %cond.or = or|and i1 %cond1, cond2
   8119     //   br i1 %cond.or label %dest1, label %dest2"
   8120     Instruction *LogicOp;
   8121     BasicBlock *TBB, *FBB;
   8122     if (!match(BB.getTerminator(),
   8123                m_Br(m_OneUse(m_Instruction(LogicOp)), TBB, FBB)))
   8124       continue;
   8125 
   8126     auto *Br1 = cast<BranchInst>(BB.getTerminator());
   8127     if (Br1->getMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_unpredictable))
   8128       continue;
   8129 
   8130     // The merging of mostly empty BB can cause a degenerate branch.
   8131     if (TBB == FBB)
   8132       continue;
   8133 
   8134     unsigned Opc;
   8135     Value *Cond1, *Cond2;
   8136     if (match(LogicOp,
   8137               m_LogicalAnd(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)), m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
   8138       Opc = Instruction::And;
   8139     else if (match(LogicOp, m_LogicalOr(m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond1)),
   8140                                         m_OneUse(m_Value(Cond2)))))
   8141       Opc = Instruction::Or;
   8142     else
   8143       continue;
   8144 
   8145     auto IsGoodCond = [](Value *Cond) {
   8146       return match(
   8147           Cond,
   8148           m_CombineOr(m_Cmp(), m_CombineOr(m_LogicalAnd(m_Value(), m_Value()),
   8149                                            m_LogicalOr(m_Value(), m_Value()))));
   8150     };
   8151     if (!IsGoodCond(Cond1) || !IsGoodCond(Cond2))
   8152       continue;
   8153 
   8154     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "Before branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump());
   8155 
   8156     // Create a new BB.
   8157     auto *TmpBB =
   8158         BasicBlock::Create(BB.getContext(), BB.getName() + ".cond.split",
   8159                            BB.getParent(), BB.getNextNode());
   8160 
   8161     // Update original basic block by using the first condition directly by the
   8162     // branch instruction and removing the no longer needed and/or instruction.
   8163     Br1->setCondition(Cond1);
   8164     LogicOp->eraseFromParent();
   8165 
   8166     // Depending on the condition we have to either replace the true or the
   8167     // false successor of the original branch instruction.
   8168     if (Opc == Instruction::And)
   8169       Br1->setSuccessor(0, TmpBB);
   8170     else
   8171       Br1->setSuccessor(1, TmpBB);
   8172 
   8173     // Fill in the new basic block.
   8174     auto *Br2 = IRBuilder<>(TmpBB).CreateCondBr(Cond2, TBB, FBB);
   8175     if (auto *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond2)) {
   8176       I->removeFromParent();
   8177       I->insertBefore(Br2);
   8178     }
   8179 
   8180     // Update PHI nodes in both successors. The original BB needs to be
   8181     // replaced in one successor's PHI nodes, because the branch comes now from
   8182     // the newly generated BB (NewBB). In the other successor we need to add one
   8183     // incoming edge to the PHI nodes, because both branch instructions target
   8184     // now the same successor. Depending on the original branch condition
   8185     // (and/or) we have to swap the successors (TrueDest, FalseDest), so that
   8186     // we perform the correct update for the PHI nodes.
   8187     // This doesn't change the successor order of the just created branch
   8188     // instruction (or any other instruction).
   8189     if (Opc == Instruction::Or)
   8190       std::swap(TBB, FBB);
   8191 
   8192     // Replace the old BB with the new BB.
   8193     TBB->replacePhiUsesWith(&BB, TmpBB);
   8194 
   8195     // Add another incoming edge form the new BB.
   8196     for (PHINode &PN : FBB->phis()) {
   8197       auto *Val = PN.getIncomingValueForBlock(&BB);
   8198       PN.addIncoming(Val, TmpBB);
   8199     }
   8200 
   8201     // Update the branch weights (from SelectionDAGBuilder::
   8202     // FindMergedConditions).
   8203     if (Opc == Instruction::Or) {
   8204       // Codegen X | Y as:
   8205       // BB1:
   8206       //   jmp_if_X TBB
   8207       //   jmp TmpBB
   8208       // TmpBB:
   8209       //   jmp_if_Y TBB
   8210       //   jmp FBB
   8211       //
   8212 
   8213       // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for NewBB.
   8214       // The requirement is that
   8215       //   TrueProb for BB1 + (FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB)
   8216       //     = TrueProb for original BB.
   8217       // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
   8218       // weights to A and A+2B, and set TmpBB's weights to A and 2B. This choice
   8219       // assumes that
   8220       //   TrueProb for BB1 == FalseProb for BB1 * TrueProb for TmpBB.
   8221       // Another choice is to assume TrueProb for BB1 equals to TrueProb for
   8222       // TmpBB, but the math is more complicated.
   8223       uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
   8224       if (Br1->extractProfMetadata(TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
   8225         uint64_t NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
   8226         uint64_t NewFalseWeight = TrueWeight + 2 * FalseWeight;
   8227         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
   8228         Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof, MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
   8229                          .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
   8230 
   8231         NewTrueWeight = TrueWeight;
   8232         NewFalseWeight = 2 * FalseWeight;
   8233         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
   8234         Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof, MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
   8235                          .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
   8236       }
   8237     } else {
   8238       // Codegen X & Y as:
   8239       // BB1:
   8240       //   jmp_if_X TmpBB
   8241       //   jmp FBB
   8242       // TmpBB:
   8243       //   jmp_if_Y TBB
   8244       //   jmp FBB
   8245       //
   8246       //  This requires creation of TmpBB after CurBB.
   8247 
   8248       // We have flexibility in setting Prob for BB1 and Prob for TmpBB.
   8249       // The requirement is that
   8250       //   FalseProb for BB1 + (TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB)
   8251       //     = FalseProb for original BB.
   8252       // Assuming the original weights are A and B, one choice is to set BB1's
   8253       // weights to 2A+B and B, and set TmpBB's weights to 2A and B. This choice
   8254       // assumes that
   8255       //   FalseProb for BB1 == TrueProb for BB1 * FalseProb for TmpBB.
   8256       uint64_t TrueWeight, FalseWeight;
   8257       if (Br1->extractProfMetadata(TrueWeight, FalseWeight)) {
   8258         uint64_t NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight + FalseWeight;
   8259         uint64_t NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
   8260         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
   8261         Br1->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof, MDBuilder(Br1->getContext())
   8262                          .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
   8263 
   8264         NewTrueWeight = 2 * TrueWeight;
   8265         NewFalseWeight = FalseWeight;
   8266         scaleWeights(NewTrueWeight, NewFalseWeight);
   8267         Br2->setMetadata(LLVMContext::MD_prof, MDBuilder(Br2->getContext())
   8268                          .createBranchWeights(TrueWeight, FalseWeight));
   8269       }
   8270     }
   8271 
   8272     ModifiedDT = true;
   8273     MadeChange = true;
   8274 
   8275     LLVM_DEBUG(dbgs() << "After branch condition splitting\n"; BB.dump();
   8276                TmpBB->dump());
   8277   }
   8278   return MadeChange;
   8279 }
   8280